blob: 9588759276696f0ec160540e5fd8757ffc1fb413 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau991b4782015-10-13 21:48:10 +02005 version 1.7
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau844028b2015-10-13 18:52:22 +02007 2015/10/13
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106
1071. Quick reminder about HTTP
108----------------------------
109
110When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
111fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
112on almost anything found in the contents.
113
114However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
115formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
116correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
117
118
1191.1. The HTTP transaction model
120-------------------------------
121
122The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100123to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
125connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
126will involve a new connection :
127
128 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
129
130In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
131establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
132by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
133length.
134
135Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
136to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
137however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
138response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
139header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
144power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
145but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200146a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147
148A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
149keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
150second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
151page :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
156latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
157correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
158the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100159server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100161By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
162connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
163leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
164start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
167 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
168 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
169 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
170 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
171 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
172 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174
1751.2. HTTP request
176-----------------
177
178First, let's consider this HTTP request :
179
180 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100181 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
183 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
184 3 User-agent: my small browser
185 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
186 5 Accept: image/png
187
188
1891.2.1. The Request line
190-----------------------
191
192Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
193
194 - a METHOD : GET
195 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
197
198All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
199which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
200followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
201is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
202desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
203the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
204
205The URI itself can have several forms :
206
207 - A "relative URI" :
208
209 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
210
211 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
212 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
213
214 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
215
216 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
217
218 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
219 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
220 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
221 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
222 must accept this form too.
223
224 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
225 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
226 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
229 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
230 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
231 other protocols too.
232
233In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
234mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
235on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
236It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
237specific to the language, framework or application in use.
238
239
2401.2.2. The request headers
241--------------------------
242
243The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
244beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
245an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
246Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
247values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
248encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
249the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
250define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
251
252Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
253their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
254"Connection:" header).
255
256The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
257that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
258is one valid form of empty line.
259
260Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
261headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
262about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
263application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
264
265Important note:
266 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
267 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
268 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
269 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
270
271
2721.3. HTTP response
273------------------
274
275An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
276messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
277
278 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100279 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
281 2 Content-length: 350
282 3 Content-Type: text/html
283
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
285codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
286response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100287continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
288the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
289following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
290sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
291(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
292correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
293such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
294state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
295over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
296if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
297information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
3001.3.1. The Response line
301------------------------
302
303Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
304
305 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
306 - a status code : 200
307 - a reason : OK
308
309The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200310 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
312 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
313 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
314 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
315
316Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
319messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
320or "Authentication Required".
321
322Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
323
324 Code When / reason
325 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
326 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
327 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100329 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
330 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331 400 for an invalid or too large request
332 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
333 accessing the stats page)
334 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
335 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
336 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
337 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
338 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
339 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
340 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
341 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
342 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
343
344The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3454.2).
346
347
3481.3.2. The response headers
349---------------------------
350
351Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
352the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
353details.
354
355
3562. Configuring HAProxy
357----------------------
358
3592.1. Configuration file format
360------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200361
362HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
363
364 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
365 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
366 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
367 "frontend" and "backend".
368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100369The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
370referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200371delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003742.2. Quoting and escaping
375-------------------------
376
377HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
378many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
379with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
380single quotes.
381
382If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
383them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
384escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
385
386Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
387
388 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
389 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
390 \\ to use a backslash
391 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
392 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
393
394Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
395the interpretation of:
396
397 space as a parameter separator
398 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
399 # hash as a comment start
400
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200401Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
402-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
403backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
404
405Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200406quoting.
407
408Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
409nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
410
411Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
412equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
413
414 Example:
415 # those are equivalents:
416 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
417 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
418 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
419 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
420 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
421
422 # those are equivalents:
423 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
424 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
425 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
426 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
427
428
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004292.3. Environment variables
430--------------------------
431
432HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
433interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
434configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
435optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
436shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
437underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
438
439 Example:
440
441 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
442
443 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
444
445 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
446
447
4482.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200449----------------
450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100451Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100452values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
453otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
454numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
455for every keyword. Supported units are :
456
457 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
458 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
459 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
460 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
461 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
462 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
463
464
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004652.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200466-------------
467
468 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
469 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
470 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
471 global
472 daemon
473 maxconn 256
474
475 defaults
476 mode http
477 timeout connect 5000ms
478 timeout client 50000ms
479 timeout server 50000ms
480
481 frontend http-in
482 bind *:80
483 default_backend servers
484
485 backend servers
486 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
487
488
489 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
490 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
491 global
492 daemon
493 maxconn 256
494
495 defaults
496 mode http
497 timeout connect 5000ms
498 timeout client 50000ms
499 timeout server 50000ms
500
501 listen http-in
502 bind *:80
503 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
504
505
506Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
507
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100508 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200509
510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005113. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200512--------------------
513
514Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
515are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
516of them have command-line equivalents.
517
518The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
519
520 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200521 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200522 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200523 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200524 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200526 - description
527 - deviceatlas-json-file
528 - deviceatlas-log-level
529 - deviceatlas-separator
530 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900531 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200532 - gid
533 - group
534 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200535 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100536 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200537 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200538 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - pidfile
541 - uid
542 - ulimit-n
543 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200544 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200545 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
546 - ssl-default-bind-options
547 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
548 - ssl-default-server-options
549 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100550 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100551 - unix-bind
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100552 - 51degrees-data-file
553 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200554 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200555 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100556
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200558 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200559 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200560 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100561 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100562 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100563 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200564 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200565 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200566 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200567 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200568 - noepoll
569 - nokqueue
570 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100571 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300572 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200573 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200574 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200575 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - tune.buffers.limit
577 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200578 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200579 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100580 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100581 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200582 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100583 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100584 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100585 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100586 - tune.lua.session-timeout
587 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200588 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100589 - tune.maxaccept
590 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200591 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200592 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200593 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100594 - tune.rcvbuf.client
595 - tune.rcvbuf.server
596 - tune.sndbuf.client
597 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100598 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100599 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200600 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100601 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200602 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200603 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200604 - tune.vars.global-max-size
605 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
606 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
607 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100608 - tune.zlib.memlevel
609 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100610
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611 * Debugging
612 - debug
613 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614
615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006163.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617------------------------------------
618
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200619ca-base <dir>
620 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200621 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
622 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200623
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624chroot <jail dir>
625 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
626 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
627 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
628 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
629 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
630 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100631
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100632cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
633 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
634 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
635 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100636 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
637 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
638 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
639 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
640 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
641 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
642 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
643 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
644 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
645 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100646
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200647crt-base <dir>
648 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
649 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
650 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
651
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200652daemon
653 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
654 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
655 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
656
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200657deviceatlas-json-file <path>
658 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
659 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
660
661deviceatlas-log-level <value>
662 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
663 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
664
665deviceatlas-separator <char>
666 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
667 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
668
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100669devicatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200670 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
671 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
672 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100673
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900674external-check
675 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
676 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
677 See "option external-check".
678
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200679gid <number>
680 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
681 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
682 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100683 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
684 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100686
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200687group <group name>
688 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
689 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100690
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200691log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200692 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
693 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100694 configured with "log global".
695
696 <address> can be one of:
697
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100698 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100699 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
700 port).
701
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100702 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
703 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
704 port).
705
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100706 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
707 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
708 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
709 writeable).
710
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200711 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
712 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100713
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200714 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
715 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
716 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
717 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
718 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
719 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
720 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
721 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
722 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
723 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
724 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
725
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200726 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
727 one of the following :
728
729 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
730 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
731
732 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
733 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
734
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100735 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200736
737 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
738 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
739 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
740
741 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200742 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
743 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
744 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
745 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
746 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
747 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200748
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200749 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200750
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100751log-send-hostname [<string>]
752 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
753 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
754 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
755 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
756 the logs.
757
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000758log-tag <string>
759 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
760 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
761 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100762 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000763
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100764lua-load <file>
765 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
766 used multiple times.
767
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200768nbproc <number>
769 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
770 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
771 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
772 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
773 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
774
775pidfile <pidfile>
776 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
777 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
778 starting the process. See also "daemon".
779
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100780stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200781 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
782 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
783 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
784 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
785 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
786 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100787 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200788 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
789 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200790
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200791server-state-base <directory>
792 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200793 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
794 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200795
796server-state-file <file>
797 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
798 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
799 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
800 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
801 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
802 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
803 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
804 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200805 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
806 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200807
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100808ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
810 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300811 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100812 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
813 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
814 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
815 "bind" keyword for more information.
816
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100817ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
819 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
820 keyword to see available options.
821
822 Example:
823 global
824 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
825
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100826ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
827 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
828 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300829 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100830 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
831 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
832 information.
833
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100834ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
835 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
836 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
837 keyword to see available options.
838
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200839ssl-dh-param-file <file>
840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
841 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
842 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
843 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
844 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200845 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
846 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
847 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
848 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200849 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
850 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
851 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
852
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100853ssl-server-verify [none|required]
854 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
855 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
856 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
857
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200858stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
859 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
860 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
861 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200862 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
863 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200864
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200865 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
866 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
867 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200868
869stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
870 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
871 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100872 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200873
874stats maxconn <connections>
875 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
876 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
877
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200878uid <number>
879 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
880 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
881 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
882 one. See also "gid" and "user".
883
884ulimit-n <number>
885 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
886 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
887 option.
888
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100889unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
890 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
891
892 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
893 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
894 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
895 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
896 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
897 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
898 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
899 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
900 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
901 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
902
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200903user <user name>
904 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
905 See also "uid" and "group".
906
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200907node <name>
908 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
909
910 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
911 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
912 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
913 traffic.
914
915description <text>
916 Add a text that describes the instance.
917
918 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
919 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
920 "<" and ">" characters.
921
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010092251degrees-data-file <file path>
923 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
924 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
925
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200926 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100927 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
928
92951degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
930 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
931 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
932 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
933
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200934 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100935 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
936
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020093751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100938 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
939 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
940
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200941 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
942 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
943
94451degrees-cache-size <number>
945 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
946 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
947 By default, this cache is disabled.
948
949 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100950 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
951
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009533.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200954-----------------------
955
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200956max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
957 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
958 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
959 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
960 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
961 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
962 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
963 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
964 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
965
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200966maxconn <number>
967 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
968 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
969 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200970 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
971 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
972 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
973 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100974 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
975 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
976 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
977 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
978 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200979
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200980maxconnrate <number>
981 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
982 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
983 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
984 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
985 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
986 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
987 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
988 fairness.
989
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100990maxcomprate <number>
991 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300992 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100993 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
994 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
995 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
996 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
997 default value.
998
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100999maxcompcpuusage <number>
1000 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1001 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1002 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1003 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1004 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1005 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1006 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1007 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1008
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001009maxpipes <number>
1010 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1011 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1012 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1013 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1014 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1015 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1016
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001017maxsessrate <number>
1018 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1019 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1020 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1021 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1022 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1023 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1024 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1025 fairness.
1026
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001027maxsslconn <number>
1028 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1029 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1030 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1031 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1032 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1033 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1034 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001035 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1036 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1037 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1038 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1039 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1040 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1041 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001042
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001043maxsslrate <number>
1044 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1045 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1046 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1047 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1048 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1049 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1050 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1051 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1052 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1053 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1054
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001055maxzlibmem <number>
1056 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1057 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1058 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001059 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1060 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1061 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1062
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001063noepoll
1064 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1065 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001066 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001067
1068nokqueue
1069 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1070 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1071 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1072
1073nopoll
1074 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1075 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001076 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001077 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001078
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001079nosplice
1080 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1081 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1082 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001083 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001084 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1085 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1086 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1087 "option splice-response".
1088
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001089nogetaddrinfo
1090 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1091 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1092
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001093spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001094 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1095 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1096 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1097 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1098 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1099 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001100
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001101tune.buffers.limit <number>
1102 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1103 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1104 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1105 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1106 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1107 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1108 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1109 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1110 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1111 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1112 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1113 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1114 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1115 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1116 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1117
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001118tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1119 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1120 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1121 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1122 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1123
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001124tune.bufsize <number>
1125 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1126 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1127 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1128 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1129 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1130 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1131 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1132 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001133 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1134 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1135 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001136
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001137tune.chksize <number>
1138 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1139 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1140 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1141 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1142 checks whenever possible.
1143
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001144tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1145 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1146 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1147 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1148 this value. The default value is 1.
1149
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001150tune.http.cookielen <number>
1151 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1152 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1153 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1154 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1155 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1156 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1157 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1158 to change this value.
1159
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001160tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1161 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1162 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1163 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1164 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1165 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1166 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1167 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1168 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1169 limit too high.
1170
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001171tune.idletimer <timeout>
1172 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1173 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1174 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1175 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1176 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1177 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1178 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1179 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1180 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1181
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001182tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1183 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1184 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1185 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1186 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1187 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1188 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1189 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1190
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001191tune.lua.maxmem
1192 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1193 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1194 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1195 memory.
1196
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001197tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1198 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001199 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1200 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1201 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001202
1203tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1204 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1205 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1206 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1207 check servers.
1208
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001209tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1210 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1211 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1212 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1213 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1214
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001215tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001216 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1217 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1218 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1219 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1220 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1221 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1222 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1223 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1224 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1225 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001226
1227tune.maxpollevents <number>
1228 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1229 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1230 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1231 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1232 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1233
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001234tune.maxrewrite <number>
1235 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1236 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1237 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1238 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1239 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1240 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1241 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1242 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1243 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1244 bufsize.
1245
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001246tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1247 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1248 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1249 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1250 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1251 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1252 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1253 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1254 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1255 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1256 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1257 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1258 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1259 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1260 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1261 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1262 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1263 setting this parameter to 0.
1264
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001265tune.pipesize <number>
1266 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1267 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1268 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1269 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1270 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1271 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1272
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001273tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1274tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1275 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1276 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1277 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1278 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1279 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1280 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1281 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1282
1283tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1284tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1285 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1286 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1287 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1288 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1289 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1290 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1291 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1292 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1293 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1294 notifying haproxy again.
1295
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001296tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001297 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1298 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1299 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001300 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001301 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1302 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1303 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1304 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1305 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001306 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1307 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001308
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001309tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1310 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1311 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1312 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1313 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1314 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1315 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1316
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001317tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1318 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001319 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001320 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1321 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1322 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1323 being used for too long.
1324
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001325tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1326 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1327 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1328 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1329 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1330 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1331 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1332 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1333 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1334 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1335 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001336 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1337 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001338
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001339tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1340 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1341 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1342 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1343 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1344 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1345 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1346 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001347 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1348 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001349
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001350tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1351 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1352 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1353 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1354 1000 entries.
1355
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001356tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1357tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1358tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1359tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
1360 These four tunes helps to manage the allowed amount of memory used by the
1361 variables system. "global" limits the memory for all the systems. "sess" limit
1362 the memory by session, "txn" limits the memory by transaction and "reqres"
1363 limits the memory for each request or response processing. during the
1364 accounting, "sess" embbed "txn" and "txn" embed "reqres".
1365
1366 By example, we considers that "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is fixed to 100,
1367 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" is fixed to 100, "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" is
1368 also fixed to 100. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1369 we cannot create any more variable in the other contexts.
1370
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001371tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1372 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001373 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001374 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1375 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1376 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1377
1378tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1379 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1380 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1381 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1382 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013843.3. Debugging
1385--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001386
1387debug
1388 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1389 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1390 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1391 system startup.
1392
1393quiet
1394 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1395 line argument "-q".
1396
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001397
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013983.4. Userlists
1399--------------
1400It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1401http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1402it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1403
1404userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001405 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001406 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1407
1408group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001409 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001410 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1411 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1412
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001413user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1414 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001415 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1416 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001417 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1418 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001419 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001420 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001421
1422
1423 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001424 userlist L1
1425 group G1 users tiger,scott
1426 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001427
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001428 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1429 user scott insecure-password elgato
1430 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001431
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001432 userlist L2
1433 group G1
1434 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001435
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001436 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1437 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1438 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001439
1440 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001442
14433.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001444----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001445It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1446several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1447instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1448values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1449automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1450In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1451using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1452tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1453reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1454Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1455that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1456each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001457
1458peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001459 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001460 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1461
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001462disabled
1463 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1464 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1465 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1466
1467enable
1468 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1469
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001470peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1471 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1472 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1473 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1474 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1475 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1476 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1477
1478 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1479 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1480
1481 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1482 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1483 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1484 across all peers.
1485
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001486 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1487 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001488
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001489 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001490 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001491 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1492 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1493 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001494
1495 backend mybackend
1496 mode tcp
1497 balance roundrobin
1498 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1499 stick on src
1500
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001501 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1502 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001503
1504
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090015053.6. Mailers
1506------------
1507It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1508If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1509in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1510
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001511mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001512 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1513 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1514
1515mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1516 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1517
1518 Example:
1519 mailers mymailers
1520 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1521 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1522
1523 backend mybackend
1524 mode tcp
1525 balance roundrobin
1526
1527 email-alert mailers mymailers
1528 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1529 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1530
1531 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1532 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1533
1534
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015354. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001536----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001537
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001538Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001539 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001540 - frontend <name>
1541 - backend <name>
1542 - listen <name>
1543
1544A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1545its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1546section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001547section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001548
1549A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1550connections.
1551
1552A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1553to forward incoming connections.
1554
1555A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1556parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1557
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001558All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1559'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1560case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1561
1562Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1563logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1564proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1565However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1566name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1567
1568Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1569and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001570bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001571protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1572modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1573arbitrary criteria.
1574
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001575In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1576a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1577the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1578
1579 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1580 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1581 between responses and new requests.
1582
1583 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1584 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1585 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1586 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1587
1588 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1589 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1590 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1591
1592 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1593 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1594 client-facing connection remains open.
1595
1596 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1597 after the end of the response.
1598
1599The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1600frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1601following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1602weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1603
1604 Backend mode
1605
1606 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1607 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1608 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1609 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1610 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1611 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1612 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1613 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1614 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1615 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1616 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001618
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001619
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016204.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1621--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001623The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1624limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1625they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1626limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001627marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001628option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001629and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1630with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1631specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001633
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001634 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1635------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1636acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001637appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001638backlog X X X -
1639balance X - X X
1640bind - X X -
1641bind-process X X X X
1642block - X X X
1643capture cookie - X X -
1644capture request header - X X -
1645capture response header - X X -
1646clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001647compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001648contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1649cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001650declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001651default-server X - X X
1652default_backend X X X -
1653description - X X X
1654disabled X X X X
1655dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001656email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001657email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001658email-alert mailers X X X X
1659email-alert myhostname X X X X
1660email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001661enabled X X X X
1662errorfile X X X X
1663errorloc X X X X
1664errorloc302 X X X X
1665-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1666errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001667force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001668fullconn X - X X
1669grace X X X X
1670hash-type X - X X
1671http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001672http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001673http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001674http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001675http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001676http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001677http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001678id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001679ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001680load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001681log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001682log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001683log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001684log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001685max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001686maxconn X X X -
1687mode X X X X
1688monitor fail - X X -
1689monitor-net X X X -
1690monitor-uri X X X -
1691option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1692option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1693option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1694option allbackups (*) X - X X
1695option checkcache (*) X - X X
1696option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1697option contstats (*) X X X -
1698option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1699option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1700option forceclose (*) X X X X
1701-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1702option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001703option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001704option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001705option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001706option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001707option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001708option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001709option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001710option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1711option httpchk X - X X
1712option httpclose (*) X X X X
1713option httplog X X X X
1714option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001715option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001716option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001717option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001718option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1719option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1720option logasap (*) X X X -
1721option mysql-check X - X X
1722option nolinger (*) X X X X
1723option originalto X X X X
1724option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001725option pgsql-check X - X X
1726option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001727option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001728option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001729option smtpchk X - X X
1730option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1731option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1732option splice-request (*) X X X X
1733option splice-response (*) X X X X
1734option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1735option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1736-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001737option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001738option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1739option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1740option tcpka X X X X
1741option tcplog X X X X
1742option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001743external-check command X - X X
1744external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001745persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1746rate-limit sessions X X X -
1747redirect - X X X
1748redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1749redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1750reqadd - X X X
1751reqallow - X X X
1752reqdel - X X X
1753reqdeny - X X X
1754reqiallow - X X X
1755reqidel - X X X
1756reqideny - X X X
1757reqipass - X X X
1758reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001759reqitarpit - X X X
1760reqpass - X X X
1761reqrep - X X X
1762-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001763reqtarpit - X X X
1764retries X - X X
1765rspadd - X X X
1766rspdel - X X X
1767rspdeny - X X X
1768rspidel - X X X
1769rspideny - X X X
1770rspirep - X X X
1771rsprep - X X X
1772server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001773server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001774source X - X X
1775srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001776stats admin - X X X
1777stats auth X X X X
1778stats enable X X X X
1779stats hide-version X X X X
1780stats http-request - X X X
1781stats realm X X X X
1782stats refresh X X X X
1783stats scope X X X X
1784stats show-desc X X X X
1785stats show-legends X X X X
1786stats show-node X X X X
1787stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001788-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1789stick match - - X X
1790stick on - - X X
1791stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001792stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001793stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001794tcp-check connect - - X X
1795tcp-check expect - - X X
1796tcp-check send - - X X
1797tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001798tcp-request connection - X X -
1799tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001800tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001801tcp-response content - - X X
1802tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001803timeout check X - X X
1804timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001805timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001806timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1807timeout connect X - X X
1808timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1809timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1810timeout http-request X X X X
1811timeout queue X - X X
1812timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001813timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001814timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1815timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001816timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001817transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001818unique-id-format X X X -
1819unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001820use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001821use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001822------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1823 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001824
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018264.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1827---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001828
1829This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1830
1831
1832acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1833 Declare or complete an access list.
1834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1835 no | yes | yes | yes
1836 Example:
1837 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1838 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1839 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1840
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001841 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001842
1843
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001844appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1845 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001846 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1848 no | no | yes | yes
1849 Arguments :
1850 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1851 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1852
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001853 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001854 checked in each cookie value.
1855
1856 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1857 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1858 milliseconds.
1859
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001860 request-learn
1861 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1862 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1863 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1864 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1865 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1866 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1867
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001868 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1869 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1870 data following this prefix.
1871
1872 Example :
1873 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1874
1875 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1876 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1877
1878 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1879 2 modes are currently supported :
1880 - path-parameters :
1881 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1882 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1883 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1884 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1885 - query-string :
1886 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1887 query string.
1888
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001889 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
1890 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
1891 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001892
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001893 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1894 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001895
1896
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001897backlog <conns>
1898 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1900 yes | yes | yes | no
1901 Arguments :
1902 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1903 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001904 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001905
1906 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1907 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1908 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1909 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1910 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1911 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1912 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1913 backlog parameter.
1914
1915 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1916 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1917 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1918
1919 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1920
1921
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001922balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001923balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001924 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1926 yes | no | yes | yes
1927 Arguments :
1928 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1929 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1930 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1931 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1932
1933 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1934 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1935 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1936 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001937 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001938 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001939 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1940 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1941 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1942 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1943 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1944 it, so that you don't worry.
1945
1946 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1947 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1948 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1949 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1950 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1951 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1952 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1953 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001954
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001955 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1956 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1957 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1958 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1959 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1960 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1961 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1962 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1963
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001964 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001965 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001966 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1967 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001968 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001969 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1970 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1971 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1972 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1973 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001974 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1975 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1976 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1977 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1978 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1979 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001980
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001981 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1982 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1983 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1984 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1985 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1986 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1987 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1988 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001989 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001990 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001991 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1992 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1993 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001994
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001995 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1996 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1997 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1998 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1999 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2000 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2001 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2002 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2003 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2004 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2005 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2006 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002007
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002008 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002009 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2010 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2011 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2012 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2013 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2014 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2015 URIs start with a leading "/".
2016
2017 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2018 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2019 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2020 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2021
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002022 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002023 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2024
2025 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002026 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2027 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002028 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2029 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2030 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2031 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002032 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002033 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2034 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002035
2036 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2037 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2038 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2039 server will receive the request.
2040
2041 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2042 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2043 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2044 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2045 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002046 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2047 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2048 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002049
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002050 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2051 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2052 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2053 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2054 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002056 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002057 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2058 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2059 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2060
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002061 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2062 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2063 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2064
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002065 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002066 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002067 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2068 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2069 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2070 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2071 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2072 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002073 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002074 used instead.
2075
2076 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2077 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2078 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2079 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2080
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002081 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2082 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2083 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2084
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002085 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002086
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002087 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002088 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2089 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002090
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002091 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2092 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2093 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002094
2095 Examples :
2096 balance roundrobin
2097 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002098 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002099 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2100 balance hdr(host)
2101 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002102
2103 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2104 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2105
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002106 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002107 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2108 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2109 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2110 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2111
2112 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2113 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2114 defaults to 16 kB.
2115
2116 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2117 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2118
2119 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2120 Round Robin.
2121
2122 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2123 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2124 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2125 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2126
2127 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2128
2129 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002130 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002131 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2132 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2133 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002135 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002136
2137
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002138bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2139bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002140 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2142 no | yes | yes | no
2143 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002144 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2145 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2146 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2147 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002148 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002149 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2150 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2151 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2152 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2153 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2154 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2155 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002156 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2157 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2158 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2159 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2160 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2161 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2162 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002163 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2164 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2165 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002166 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2167 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2168 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002169
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002170 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2171 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002172 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2173 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2174 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002175 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2176 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2177 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2178 the range.
2179
2180 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2181 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2182 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2183 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2184 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2185 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2186 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002187 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002188 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002189
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002190 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2191 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2192 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2193 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2194 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2195 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2196 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2197 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2198
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002199 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2200 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2201 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2202 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002203
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002204 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2205 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2206 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2207 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2208 in a frontend.
2209
2210 Example :
2211 listen http_proxy
2212 bind :80,:443
2213 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002214 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002215
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002216 listen http_https_proxy
2217 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002218 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002219
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002220 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2221 bind ipv6@:80
2222 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2223 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2224
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002225 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002226 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002227
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002228 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2229 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2230 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2231 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2232 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2233
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002234 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002235 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002236
2237
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002238bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002239 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2241 yes | yes | yes | yes
2242 Arguments :
2243 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2244 may be used to override a default value.
2245
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002246 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002247 option may be combined with other numbers.
2248
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002249 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002250 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2251 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2252 missing from all processes.
2253
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002254 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002255 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002256 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2257 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2258 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2259 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002260
2261 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2262 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2263 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2264 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2265 and 'even' instances.
2266
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002267 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2268 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2269 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2270 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002271
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002272 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2273 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2274
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002275 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2276 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2277 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2278
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002279 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2280 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2281
2282 Example :
2283 listen app_ip1
2284 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002285 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002286
2287 listen app_ip2
2288 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002289 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002290
2291 listen management
2292 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002293 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002294
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002295 listen management
2296 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2297 bind-process 1-4
2298
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002299 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002300
2301
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002302block { if | unless } <condition>
2303 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2305 no | yes | yes | yes
2306
2307 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2308 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002309 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002310 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002311 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2312 "block" statements per instance.
2313
2314 Example:
2315 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2316 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2317 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2318 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002320 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002321
2322
2323capture cookie <name> len <length>
2324 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2326 no | yes | yes | no
2327 Arguments :
2328 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2329 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2330 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2331 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2332 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2333
2334 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2335 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2336 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2337 right if it exceeds <length>.
2338
2339 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2340 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2341 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2342 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2343
2344 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2345 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2346 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2347
2348 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2349 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2350 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002351 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2352 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2353 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002354
2355 Example:
2356 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2357
2358 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002359 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002360
2361
2362capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002363 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2365 no | yes | yes | no
2366 Arguments :
2367 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002368 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2370 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2371 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2372
2373 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2374 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2375 it exceeds <length>.
2376
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002377 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2379 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002380 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2381 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2382 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2383 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002384 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002385 environments to find where the request came from.
2386
2387 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2388 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2389 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2390 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002391
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002392 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2393 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2394 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2395 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2396 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002397
2398 Example:
2399 capture request header Host len 15
2400 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2401 capture request header Referrer len 15
2402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002403 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002404 about logging.
2405
2406
2407capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002408 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2410 no | yes | yes | no
2411 Arguments :
2412 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002413 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002414 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2415 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2416 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2417
2418 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2419 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2420 it exceeds <length>.
2421
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002422 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002423 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2424 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2425 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002426 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2427 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2428 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2429 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002430
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002431 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2432 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2433 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2434 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2435 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436
2437 Example:
2438 capture response header Content-length len 9
2439 capture response header Location len 15
2440
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002441 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002442 about logging.
2443
2444
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002445clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002446 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2448 yes | yes | yes | no
2449 Arguments :
2450 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2451 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2452 as explained at the top of this document.
2453
2454 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2455 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2456 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2457 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2458 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2459 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2460 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2461 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002462 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002463 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2464 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2465
2466 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2467 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2468 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2469 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2470 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2471 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2472
2473 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2474 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2475
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002476 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2477 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002478
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002479compression algo <algorithm> ...
2480compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002481compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002482 Enable HTTP compression.
2483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2484 yes | yes | yes | yes
2485 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002486 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2487 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2488 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2489
2490 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002491 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2492 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2493 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002494
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002495 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2496 support for zlib was built in.
2497
2498 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2499 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2500 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2501 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2502 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2503 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002504
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002505 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2506 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2507 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2508 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2509 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2510 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2511 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2512 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002513
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002514 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002515 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002516 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2517 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2518 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2519 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2520 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002521
2522 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2523 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2524 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2525 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2526 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002527 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2528 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2529 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2530 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2531 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002532 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2533 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002534
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002535 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002536 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2537 "Accept-Encoding" header
2538 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002539 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002540 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2541 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002542 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2543 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2544 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2545 "multipart"
2546 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2547 header
2548 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2549 and later
2550 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2551 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002552
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002553 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2554 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002555
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002556 Examples :
2557 compression algo gzip
2558 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002559
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002560contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2563 yes | no | yes | yes
2564 Arguments :
2565 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2566 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2567 as explained at the top of this document.
2568
2569 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002570 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002571 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002572 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2573 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2574 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2575 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2576
2577 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2578 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2579 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2580 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2581 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2582 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2583
2584 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2585 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2586 instead.
2587
2588 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2589 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2590
2591
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002592cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002593 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2594 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002595 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2597 yes | no | yes | yes
2598 Arguments :
2599 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2600 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2601 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2602 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2603 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2604 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2605 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2606 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2607 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2608
2609 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2610 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2611 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2612 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2613 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2614 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2615 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2616 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2617 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2618 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2619 "insert" and "prefix".
2620
2621 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002622 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002623
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002624 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002625 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2626 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2627 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2628 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2629 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2630 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2631 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2632 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2633 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2634 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002635
2636 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2637 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2638 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2639 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2640 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2641 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2642 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2643 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2644 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2645 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002646 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2647 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2648 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002649
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002650 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2651 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2652 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002653 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2654 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2655 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2656 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002657 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2658 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2659 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002660
2661 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2662 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2663 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2664 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2665 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2666 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2667 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2668 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2669 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2670
2671 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2672 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2673 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2674 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2675 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2676 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2677 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2678 persistence cookie in the cache.
2679 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2680
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002681 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2682 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2683 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2684 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2685 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2686 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2687 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2688 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2689 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2690 they logout.
2691
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002692 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2693 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2694 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2695 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2696
2697 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2698 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2699 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2700 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2701 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2702 this attribute.
2703
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002704 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002705 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002706 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2707 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2708 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2709 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2710 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2711 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002712
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002713 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2714 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2715 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2716 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2717 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2718 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2719 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2720 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2721 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2722 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2723 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2724 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2725 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2726 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2727 the site.
2728
2729 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2730 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2731 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2732 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2733 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2734 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2735 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2736 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2737 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2738 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2739 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2740 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2741 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2742 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2743 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2744 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2745
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002746 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2747 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2748 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2749 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002750
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751 Examples :
2752 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2753 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2754 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002755 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002756
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002757 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002758
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002759
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002760declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2761 Declares a capture slot.
2762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2763 no | yes | yes | no
2764 Arguments:
2765 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2766
2767 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2768 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2769 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2770 for use in the response.
2771
2772 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
2773 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2774
2775
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002776default-server [param*]
2777 Change default options for a server in a backend
2778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2779 yes | no | yes | yes
2780 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002781 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2782 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2783 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2784 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002785
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002786 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002787 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2788
2789 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002790
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002791
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002792default_backend <backend>
2793 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2795 yes | yes | yes | no
2796 Arguments :
2797 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2798
2799 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2800 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2801 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2802 will catch all undetermined requests.
2803
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002804 Example :
2805
2806 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2807 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2808 default_backend dynamic
2809
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002810 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002811
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002812
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002813description <string>
2814 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2816 no | yes | yes | yes
2817 Arguments : string
2818
2819 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2820 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2821 it describes.
2822 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2823
2824
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002825disabled
2826 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2828 yes | yes | yes | yes
2829 Arguments : none
2830
2831 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2832 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2833 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2834 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2835 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2836 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2837 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2838
2839 See also : "enabled"
2840
2841
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002842dispatch <address>:<port>
2843 Set a default server address
2844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2845 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002846 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002847
2848 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2849 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2850 during start-up.
2851
2852 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2853 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2854 possible with normal servers.
2855
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002856 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002857 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2858 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2859 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2860 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2861
2862 See also : "server"
2863
2864
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002865enabled
2866 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2868 yes | yes | yes | yes
2869 Arguments : none
2870
2871 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2872 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2873
2874 See also : "disabled"
2875
2876
2877errorfile <code> <file>
2878 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2880 yes | yes | yes | yes
2881 Arguments :
2882 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002883 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2884 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002885
2886 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002887 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002888 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002889 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2890 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891
2892 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2893 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2894 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2895
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002896 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2897
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002898 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2899 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2900 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2901 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2902
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002903 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2904 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2905 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2906 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2907 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2908 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2909
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002910 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2911 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2912 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002913 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002914 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2915
2916 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2917
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002918 Example :
2919 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002920 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002921 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2922 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2923
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002924
2925errorloc <code> <url>
2926errorloc302 <code> <url>
2927 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2929 yes | yes | yes | yes
2930 Arguments :
2931 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002932 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002933
2934 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2935 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2936 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2937 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2938 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2939
2940 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2941 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2942 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2943
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002944 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2945
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002946 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2947 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2948 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2949 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2950 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2951 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2952 request.
2953
2954 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2955
2956
2957errorloc303 <code> <url>
2958 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2960 yes | yes | yes | yes
2961 Arguments :
2962 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2963 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2964
2965 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2966 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2967 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2968 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2969 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2970
2971 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2972 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2973 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2974
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002975 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2976
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002977 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2978 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2979 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2980 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002981 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002982
2983 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2984
2985
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002986email-alert from <emailaddr>
2987 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2988 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2989 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2990 yes | yes | yes | yes
2991
2992 Arguments :
2993
2994 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2995
2996 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2997 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2998
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002999 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003000 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3001 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003002
3003
3004email-alert level <level>
3005 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3006 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3007 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3008 yes | yes | yes | yes
3009
3010 Arguments :
3011
3012 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3013 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3014 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3015
3016 By default level is alert
3017
3018 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3019 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3020 for the proxy.
3021
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003022 Alerts are sent when :
3023
3024 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3025 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3026 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3027 is notice or lower
3028 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3029 and a health check status update occurs
3030
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003031 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3032 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003033 section 3.6 about mailers.
3034
3035
3036email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3037 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3038 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3039 yes | yes | yes | yes
3040
3041 Arguments :
3042
3043 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3044
3045 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3046 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3047
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003048 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3049 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003050
3051
3052email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3053 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3054 mailers.
3055 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3056 yes | yes | yes | yes
3057
3058 Arguments :
3059
3060 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3061
3062 By default the systems hostname is used.
3063
3064 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3065 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3066 for the proxy.
3067
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003068 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3069 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003070
3071
3072email-alert to <emailaddr>
3073 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3074 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3075 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3076 yes | yes | yes | yes
3077
3078 Arguments :
3079
3080 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3081
3082 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3083 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3084
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003085 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003086 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3087
3088
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003089force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3090 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3091 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3092 no | yes | yes | yes
3093
3094 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3095 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3096 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3097 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3098 marked down for maintenance operations.
3099
3100 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3101 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3102 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3103 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3104 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3105 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3106 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3107 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3108 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3109
3110 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3111 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3112 is used.
3113
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003114 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003115 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003116
3117
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003118fullconn <conns>
3119 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3121 yes | no | yes | yes
3122 Arguments :
3123 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3124 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3125
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003126 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003127 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003128 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003129 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3130 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3131 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3132 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3133 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003134 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003135
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003136 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3137 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003138 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3139 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3140 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003141
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003142 Example :
3143 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3144 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3145 # connections.
3146 backend dynamic
3147 fullconn 10000
3148 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3149 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3150
3151 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3152
3153
3154grace <time>
3155 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003157 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003158 Arguments :
3159 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3160 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3161 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3162
3163 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3164 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003165 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003166 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3167
3168 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3169 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3170 simplify it.
3171
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003172
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003173hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003174 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3176 yes | no | yes | yes
3177 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003178 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3179 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003180
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003181 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3182 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3183 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3184 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3185 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3186 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3187 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3188 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3189 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3190 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003191
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003192 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3193 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3194 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3195 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3196 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3197 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3198 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3199 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3200 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3201 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3202 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3203 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3204 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003205 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3206 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003207
3208 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3209
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003210 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003211 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3212 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3213 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003214 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3215 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3216 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003217
3218 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3219 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003220 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3221 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3222 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3223 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3224
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003225 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3226 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3227 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3228 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3229 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3230 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3231 parameter.
3232
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003233 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3234 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3235 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3236 used on strings.
3237
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003238 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3239
3240 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3241 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3242 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3243 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3244 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3245 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3246 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3247 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3248 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3249 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3250 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3251 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003252
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003253 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3254 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3255 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003256
3257 See also : "balance", "server"
3258
3259
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003260http-check disable-on-404
3261 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003263 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003264 Arguments : none
3265
3266 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3267 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3268 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3269 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3270 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3271 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3272 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3273 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003274 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3275 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3276 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3277
3278 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3279
3280
3281http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003282 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003284 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003285 Arguments :
3286 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3287 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003288 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003289 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3290 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3291 details on the supported keywords.
3292
3293 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3294 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3295 with the usual backslash ('\').
3296
3297 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3298 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3299 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3300 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3301 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3302
3303 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003304 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003305 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3306 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3307 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3308
3309 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003310 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003311 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3312 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3313 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3314 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3315
3316 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003317 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003318 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3319 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3320 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3321 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3322 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3323 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3324 trace).
3325
3326 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003327 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003328 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3329 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3330 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3331 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3332 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3333 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3334
3335 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3336 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3337 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3338 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3339 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3340 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3341 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3342 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3343
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003344 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3345 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3346 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3347
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003348 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3349 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3350
3351 Examples :
3352 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003353 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003354
3355 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003356 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003357
3358 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003359 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003360
3361 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003362 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003363
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003364 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003365
3366
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003367http-check send-state
3368 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3370 yes | no | yes | yes
3371 Arguments : none
3372
3373 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3374 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3375 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3376 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3377 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3378
3379 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3380 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3381 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3382 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3383 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003384 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3385 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3386 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3387
3388 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3389 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3390 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3391
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003392 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3393 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3394 checked in multiple backends.
3395
3396 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3397 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3398
3399 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3400 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3401 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3402 one fails.
3403
3404 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3405 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3406 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3407
3408 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3409 server's queue.
3410
3411 Example of a header received by the application server :
3412 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3413 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3414
3415 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3416
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003417http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003418 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003419 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003420 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003421 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3422 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003423 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3424 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003425 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3426 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3427 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003428 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003429 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003430 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003431 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003432 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003433 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003434 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003435 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003436 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3437
3438 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3439 no | yes | yes | yes
3440
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003441 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3442 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3443 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3444 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3445 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003446
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003447 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3448 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3449 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3450
3451 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3452 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3453 are evaluated.
3454
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003455 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3456 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3457 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3458 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3459 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3460 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3461 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3462 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3463 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003464 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003465 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3466 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003467
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003468 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3469 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3470 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3471 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3472 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3473
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003474 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3475 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3476 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003477 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3478 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003479
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003480 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3481 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3482 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3483 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3484 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3485 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3486 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3487 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3488
3489 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3490 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3491 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003492 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3493 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003494
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003495 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3496 <name>.
3497
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003498 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3499 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3500 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3501 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3502 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3503 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3504 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3505 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3506
3507 Example:
3508
3509 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3510
3511 applied to:
3512
3513 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3514
3515 outputs:
3516
3517 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3518
3519 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3520
3521 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3522 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3523 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3524 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3525 header.
3526
3527 Example:
3528
3529 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3530
3531 applied to:
3532
3533 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3534
3535 outputs:
3536
3537 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3538
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003539 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3540 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3541 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3542 it.
3543
3544 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3545 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3546 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3547 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3548 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3549 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3550
3551 Example :
3552 # prepend the host name before the path
3553 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3554
3555 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3556 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3557 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3558 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3559 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3560 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3561 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3562 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3563
3564 Example :
3565 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3566 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3567
3568 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3569 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3570 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3571 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3572 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3573 "set-query".
3574
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003575 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3576 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3577 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3578 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3579 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3580 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3581 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3582 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3583
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003584 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3585 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3586 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3587 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3588 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3589 another equipment.
3590
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003591 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3592 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3593 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3594 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3595 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3596 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3597 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3598 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3599
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003600 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3601 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3602 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3603 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3604 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3605 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3606 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3607 admin privileges.
3608
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003609 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3610 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3611 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3612 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3613 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3614 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3615 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3616 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3617
3618 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3619 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3620 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3621 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3622 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3623 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3624
3625 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3626 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3627 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3628 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3629 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3630 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3631
3632 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3633 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3634 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3635 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3636 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3637 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3638 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3639 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3640 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3641
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003642 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003643 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3644 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3645 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3646 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3647 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3648 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3649 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3650 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3651 request header" for more information.
3652
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003653 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3654 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3655 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3656 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
3657
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003658 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3659 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3660 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3661 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3662 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3663 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3664 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3665 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3666 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3667 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3668 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3669 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3670
3671 These actions take one or two arguments :
3672 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3673 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3674 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3675 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3676
3677 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3678 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3679 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3680 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3681
3682 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3683 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3684 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3685 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3686 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3687 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3688 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3689 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3690
3691 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3692 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3693 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3694 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3695 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3696
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003697 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3698 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3699 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3700 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3701 continues.
3702
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003703 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3704 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3705 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3706 the actions evaluation continues.
3707
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003708 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3709 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3710 inline.
3711
3712 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3713 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3714 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3715 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3716 (request and response)
3717 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3718 processing
3719 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3720 processing.
3721 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3722 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3723 and '_'.
3724
3725 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3726 followed by some converters.
3727
3728 Example:
3729
3730 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3731
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003732 - set-src <expr> :
3733 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3734 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3735 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3736 source IP for privacy.
3737
3738 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3739 followed by some converters.
3740
3741 Example:
3742
3743 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3744 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3745
3746 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
3747
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003748 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
3749 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
3750 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
3751 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
3752 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
3753 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
3754 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
3755 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
3756 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
3757 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
3758 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
3759 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
3760 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
3761 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
3762 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
3763 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
3764
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003765 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3766
3767 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3768 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3769 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3770 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003771
3772 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003773 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3774 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3775 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003776
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003777 http-request allow if nagios
3778 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3779 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3780 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003781
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003782 Example:
3783 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003784 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003785
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003786 Example:
3787 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3788 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02003789 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003790 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3791 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3792 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3793 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3794 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3795 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3796
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003797 Example:
3798 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3799 acl add path /addacl
3800 acl del path /delacl
3801
3802 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3803
3804 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3805 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3806
3807 Example:
3808 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3809 acl setmap path /setmap
3810 acl delmap path /delmap
3811
3812 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3813
3814 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3815 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3816
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003817 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3818 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003819
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003820http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003821 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003822 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003823 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3824 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003825 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003826 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3827 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3828 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3829 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003830 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003831 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003832 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003833 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003834 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003835 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003836 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003837 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3838
3839 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3840 no | yes | yes | yes
3841
3842 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3843 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3844 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3845 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3846 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3847 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3848
3849 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3850 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3851 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3852 current section.
3853
3854 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3855 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3856 rules are evaluated.
3857
3858 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3859 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3860 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3861 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3862 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3863 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3864 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3865
3866 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3867 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3868 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3869 external users.
3870
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003871 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3872 <name>.
3873
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003874 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3875 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3876 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3877 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3878 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3879 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3880 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3881 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3882
3883 Example:
3884
3885 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3886
3887 applied to:
3888
3889 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3890
3891 outputs:
3892
3893 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3894
3895 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3896
3897 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3898 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3899 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3900 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3901 header.
3902
3903 Example:
3904
3905 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3906
3907 applied to:
3908
3909 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3910
3911 outputs:
3912
3913 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3914
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003915 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
3916 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
3917 adapted to the new code.
3918
3919 Example:
3920
3921 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
3922 http-response set-status 431
3923
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003924 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3925 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3926 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3927 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3928 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3929 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3930 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3931 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3932
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003933 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3934 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3935 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3936 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3937 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3938 another equipment.
3939
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003940 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3941 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3942 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3943 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3944 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3945 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3946 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3947 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3948
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003949 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3950 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3951 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3952 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3953 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3954 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3955 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3956 admin privileges.
3957
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003958 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3959 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3960 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3961 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3962 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3963 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3964 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3965 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3966
3967 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3968 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3969 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3970 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3971 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3972 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3973
3974 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3975 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3976 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3977 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3978 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3979 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3980
3981 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3982 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3983 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3984 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3985 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3986 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3987 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3988 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3989 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3990
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02003991 - capture <sample> id <id> :
3992 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
3993 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
3994 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
3995 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
3996 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
3997 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3998 response header" for more information.
3999
4000 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4001 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4002 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4003 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4004 keyword.
4005
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004006 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4007 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4008 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4009 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4010 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4011 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4012
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004013 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4014 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4015 inline.
4016
4017 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
4018 scope. The allowed scopes are:
4019 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
4020 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
4021 (request and response)
4022 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
4023 processing
4024 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
4025 processing.
4026 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4027 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4028 and '_'.
4029
4030 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4031 followed by some converters.
4032
4033 Example:
4034
4035 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4036
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004037 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4038 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4039 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4040 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4041 continues.
4042
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004043 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4044 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4045 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4046 the actions evaluation continues.
4047
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004048 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4049 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4050 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4051 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4052 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4053 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4054 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4055 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4056 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4057 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4058 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4059 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4060 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4061 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4062 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4063 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4064
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004065 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4066
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004067 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004068 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
4069 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
4070 rules.
4071
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004072 Example:
4073 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4074
4075 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4076
4077 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4078 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4079
4080 Example:
4081 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4082
4083 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4084
4085 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4086 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4087
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004088 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4089 ACL usage.
4090
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004091
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004092http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4093 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4094
4095 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4096 yes | no | yes | yes
4097
4098 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4099 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4100 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4101 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4102 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4103 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4104
4105 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4106
4107 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4108 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4109 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4110 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4111 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4112 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4113 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4114 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4115 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4116 not checking any request past the first one.
4117
4118 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4119 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4120 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4121 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4122 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4123 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4124 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4125
4126 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4127 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4128 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4129 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4130 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4131 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4132 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4133 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4134 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4135 downsides of rare connection failures.
4136
4137 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4138 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4139 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4140 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4141 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4142 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4143 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4144 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4145 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4146 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4147 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4148 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4149
4150 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4151 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4152 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4153 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4154
4155 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4156 and are never shared ;
4157
4158 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4159 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4160 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4161 and are never shared ;
4162
4163 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4164 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4165 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4166
4167 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4168 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4169 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4170
4171 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4172
4173
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004174http-send-name-header [<header>]
4175 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4176
4177 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4178 yes | no | yes | yes
4179
4180 Arguments :
4181
4182 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4183
4184 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4185 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4186 is added with the header string proved.
4187
4188 See also : "server"
4189
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004190id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004191 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4193 no | yes | yes | yes
4194 Arguments : none
4195
4196 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4197 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4198 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004199
4200
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004201ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4202 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4203 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4204 no | yes | yes | yes
4205
4206 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4207 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4208 and running).
4209
4210 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4211 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4212 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004213 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004214 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4215
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004216 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4217 "unless" condition is met.
4218
4219 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4220
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004221load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4222 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4223 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4224 yes | no | yes | yes
4225
4226 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4227 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4228 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4229 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4230 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4231 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4232 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4233 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4234
4235 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4236 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004237 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004238
4239 Arguments:
4240 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4241 named "server-state-file".
4242
4243 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4244 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4245 name is used as a file name.
4246
4247 none don't load any stat for this backend
4248
4249 Notes:
4250 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4251 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4252 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4253
4254 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4255 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4256
4257 Example 1:
4258
4259 Minimal configuration:
4260
4261 global
4262 stats socket /tmp/socket
4263 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
4264
4265 defaults
4266 load-server-state-from-file global
4267
4268 backend bk
4269 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4270 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4271
4272 Then one can run :
4273
4274 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4275
4276 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4277
4278 1
4279 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4280 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4281 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4282
4283 Example 2:
4284
4285 Minimal configuration:
4286
4287 global
4288 stats socket /tmp/socket
4289 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4290
4291 defaults
4292 load-server-state-from-file local
4293
4294 backend bk
4295 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4296 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4297
4298 Then one can run :
4299
4300 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4301
4302 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4303
4304 1
4305 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4306 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4307 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4308
4309 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4310 "show servers state"
4311
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004312
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004313log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004314log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004315no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004316 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4318 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004319
4320 Prefix :
4321 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4322 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4323 prefix does not allow arguments.
4324
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004325 Arguments :
4326 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4327 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4328 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4329 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4330 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4331 parameter.
4332
4333 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4334 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4335
4336 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4337 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4338 standard syslog port).
4339
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004340 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4341 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4342 standard syslog port).
4343
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004344 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4345 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4346 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4347 appropriately writeable).
4348
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004349 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4350 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004351
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004352 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4353 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4354 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4355 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4356 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4357 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4358 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4359 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4360 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4361 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4362 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4363
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004364 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4365
4366 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4367 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4368 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4369
4370 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4371 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4372 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004373 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4374 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4375 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4376 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4377 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004378
4379 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4380
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004381 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4382 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4383 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004384
4385 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4386 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4387 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4388 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4389
4390 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4391 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004392
4393 Example :
4394 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004395 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4396 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004397 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004398
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004399
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004400log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004401 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4402 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4403 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004404
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004405 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4406 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4407 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4408 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4409 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004410
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004411log-format-sd <string>
4412 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4413 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4414 yes | yes | yes | no
4415
4416 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4417 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4418 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4419 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4420 which covers the log format string in depth.
4421
4422 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4423 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4424
4425 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4426 log format to "rfc5424".
4427
4428 Example :
4429 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4430
4431
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004432log-tag <string>
4433 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4434 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4435 yes | yes | yes | yes
4436
4437 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4438 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4439 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4440 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4441 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4442 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4443 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4444 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4445 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004446
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004447max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4448 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4449 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4450 yes | no | yes | yes
4451
4452 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4453 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4454 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4455 servers.
4456
4457 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4458 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4459 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4460 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4461 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4462 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4463 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4464 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4465 picking a different server.
4466
4467 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4468 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4469 even if they have to be queued.
4470
4471 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4472 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4473
4474
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004475maxconn <conns>
4476 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4478 yes | yes | yes | no
4479 Arguments :
4480 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4481 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4482 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4483 closes.
4484
4485 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4486 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4487 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4488 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
4489 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
4490 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
4491 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
4492 properly tuned.
4493
4494 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4495 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4496 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4497
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004498 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4499
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004500 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4501
4502
4503mode { tcp|http|health }
4504 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4506 yes | yes | yes | yes
4507 Arguments :
4508 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4509 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4510 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4511 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4512
4513 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4514 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4515 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4516 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4517 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4518
4519 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004520 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4521 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4522 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4523 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4524 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4525 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4526 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004527
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004528 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4529 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4530 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004531
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004532 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004533 defaults http_instances
4534 mode http
4535
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004536 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004538
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004539monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004540 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4542 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004543 Arguments :
4544 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4545 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004546 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004547 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4548 backend and its backup.
4549
4550 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4551 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4552 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4553 servers in a list of backends.
4554
4555 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4556 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4557 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4558 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4559 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4560 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4561 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004562 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4563 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004564
4565 Example:
4566 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004567 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004568 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4569 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4570 monitor-uri /site_alive
4571 monitor fail if site_dead
4572
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004573 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004574
4575
4576monitor-net <source>
4577 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4579 yes | yes | yes | no
4580 Arguments :
4581 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4582 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4583 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4584 followed by a mask.
4585
4586 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4587 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004588 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004589 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4590
4591 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4592 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4593 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4594 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004595 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4596 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4597 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004598
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004599 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4600 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4601 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4602 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4603 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4604 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004605
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004606 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4607 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004608
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004609 Example :
4610 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4611 frontend www
4612 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4613
4614 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4615
4616
4617monitor-uri <uri>
4618 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4620 yes | yes | yes | no
4621 Arguments :
4622 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4623 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4624
4625 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4626 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4627 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4628 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4629 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4630 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4631 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4632 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4633
4634 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4635 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4636 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4637 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4638 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4639 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4640
4641 Example :
4642 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4643 frontend www
4644 mode http
4645 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4646
4647 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4648
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004649
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004650option abortonclose
4651no option abortonclose
4652 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4654 yes | no | yes | yes
4655 Arguments : none
4656
4657 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4658 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4659 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4660 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004661 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004662 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4663 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4664 encountered while delivering the response.
4665
4666 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4667 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4668 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4669 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4670 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4671 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004672 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004673 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004674 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004675 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4676 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4677 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4678
4679 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4680 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4681 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4682 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4683 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4684 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4685 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4686 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004687 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004688
4689 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4690 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4691
4692 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4693
4694
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004695option accept-invalid-http-request
4696no option accept-invalid-http-request
4697 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4699 yes | yes | yes | no
4700 Arguments : none
4701
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004702 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004703 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4704 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4705 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4706 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4707 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4708 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4709 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004710 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4711 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4712 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4713 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4714 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004715 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004716 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4717 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4718 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004719
4720 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4721 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4722 been confirmed.
4723
4724 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4725 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004726 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4727 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004728 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4729
4730 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4731 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4732
4733 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4734 stats socket.
4735
4736
4737option accept-invalid-http-response
4738no option accept-invalid-http-response
4739 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4741 yes | no | yes | yes
4742 Arguments : none
4743
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004744 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004745 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4746 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4747 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4748 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4749 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4750 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4751 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004752 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4753 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4754 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004755
4756 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4757 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4758 been confirmed.
4759
4760 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4761 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4762 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4763 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4764
4765 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4766 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4767
4768 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4769 stats socket.
4770
4771
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004772option allbackups
4773no option allbackups
4774 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4776 yes | no | yes | yes
4777 Arguments : none
4778
4779 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4780 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4781 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4782 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4783 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4784 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4785 order between the backup servers anymore.
4786
4787 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4788 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4789
4790 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4791 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4792
4793
4794option checkcache
4795no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004796 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4798 yes | no | yes | yes
4799 Arguments : none
4800
4801 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4802 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004803 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004804 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4805 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004806 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004807
4808 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004809 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004810 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004811 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4812 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004813 to the client are :
4814 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004815 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004816 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004817 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4818 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4819 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4820 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4821 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4822 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4823 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4824 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4825 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4826 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4827 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4828
4829 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004830 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004831 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004832 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004833 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4834
4835 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4836 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004837 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004838 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4839
4840 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4841 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4842
4843
4844option clitcpka
4845no option clitcpka
4846 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4848 yes | yes | yes | no
4849 Arguments : none
4850
4851 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4852 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4853 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4854 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4855
4856 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4857 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4858 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4859 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4860
4861 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4862 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4863 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4864 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4865 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4866
4867 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4868
4869 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4870 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4871 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4872
4873 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4874 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4875
4876 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4877
4878
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004879option contstats
4880 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4882 yes | yes | yes | no
4883 Arguments : none
4884
4885 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4886 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4887 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4888 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4889 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4890 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4891 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4892
4893
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004894option dontlog-normal
4895no option dontlog-normal
4896 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4898 yes | yes | yes | no
4899 Arguments : none
4900
4901 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4902 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4903 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4904 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4905 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4906 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4907 logged.
4908
4909 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4910 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4911 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004913 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004914 logging.
4915
4916
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004917option dontlognull
4918no option dontlognull
4919 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4921 yes | yes | yes | no
4922 Arguments : none
4923
4924 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4925 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4926 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4927 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4928 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4929 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004930 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4931 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4932 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004933
4934 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4935 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4936 would not be logged.
4937
4938 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4939 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4940
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004941 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4942 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004943
4944
4945option forceclose
4946no option forceclose
4947 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004949 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004950 Arguments : none
4951
4952 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4953 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4954 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4955 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4956 global session times in the logs.
4957
4958 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004959 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004960 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004961
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004962 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4963 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4964 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4965
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004966 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4967 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004968
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004969 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4970 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4971
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004972 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004973
4974
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004975option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004976 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4978 yes | yes | yes | yes
4979 Arguments :
4980 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4981 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004982 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004983 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004984
4985 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4986 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4987 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4988 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4989 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4990 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4991 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004992 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4993 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4994 possible that the client has already brought one.
4995
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004996 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004997 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004998 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4999 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005000 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5001 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005002
5003 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5004 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5005 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5006 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5007 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5008 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5009 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5010
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005011 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5012 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5013 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5014 are under the control of the end-user.
5015
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005016 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005017 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5018 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005019 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5020 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5021 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005022
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005023 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005024 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5025 frontend www
5026 mode http
5027 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5028
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005029 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5030 backend www
5031 mode http
5032 option forwardfor header X-Client
5033
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005034 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005035 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005036
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005037
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005038option http-buffer-request
5039no option http-buffer-request
5040 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5042 yes | yes | yes | yes
5043 Arguments : none
5044
5045 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5046 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5047 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5048 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5049 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5050 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5051 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5052 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5053 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5054 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5055 default.
5056
5057 See also : "option http-no-delay"
5058
5059
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005060option http-ignore-probes
5061no option http-ignore-probes
5062 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5064 yes | yes | yes | no
5065 Arguments : none
5066
5067 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5068 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5069 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5070 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5071 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5072 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5073 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5074 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5075 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5076 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5077 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5078 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5079
5080 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5081 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5082 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5083 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5084 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5085 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5086 are often the only way to detect them.
5087
5088 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5089 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5090
5091 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5092
5093
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005094option http-keep-alive
5095no option http-keep-alive
5096 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5098 yes | yes | yes | yes
5099 Arguments : none
5100
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005101 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5102 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5103 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5104 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5105 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5106 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5107 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5108
5109 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5110 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005111 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5112 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5113 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5114 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5115 situations where this option may be useful :
5116
5117 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5118 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5119
5120 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5121 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5122
5123 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5124 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5125 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5126 request.
5127
5128 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5129 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005130 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5131 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5132 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005133
5134 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5135 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5136
5137 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5138 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5139 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5140 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5141 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5142 not set.
5143
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005144 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5145 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005146 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005147 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005148
5149 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005150 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5151 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005152
5153
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005154option http-no-delay
5155no option http-no-delay
5156 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5158 yes | yes | yes | yes
5159 Arguments : none
5160
5161 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5162 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5163 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5164 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5165 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5166 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5167 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5168 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5169 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5170 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5171 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5172 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5173 affected.
5174
5175 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5176 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5177 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5178 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5179 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5180 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5181 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5182 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5183 latency environments.
5184
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005185 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5186
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005187
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005188option http-pretend-keepalive
5189no option http-pretend-keepalive
5190 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5192 yes | yes | yes | yes
5193 Arguments : none
5194
5195 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5196 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5197 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5198 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5199 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5200 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5201 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5202 consider the response complete.
5203
5204 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5205 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5206 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5207 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5208 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5209 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5210
5211 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5212 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5213 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5214 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5215 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5216 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5217 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5218
5219 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5220 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005221 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005222 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5223 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005224
5225 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5226 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5227
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005228 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5229 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005230
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005231
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005232option http-server-close
5233no option http-server-close
5234 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5236 yes | yes | yes | yes
5237 Arguments : none
5238
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005239 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5240 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5241 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5242 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5243 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5244 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5245 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5246 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5247 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5248 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5249 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5250 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5251 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5252 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5253 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5254 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005255
5256 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5257 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5258 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5259 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005260 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5261 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005262
5263 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5264 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005265 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5266 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005267 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5268 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005269
5270 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5271 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5272
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005273 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005274 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5275 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005276
5277
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005278option http-tunnel
5279no option http-tunnel
5280 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5282 yes | yes | yes | yes
5283 Arguments : none
5284
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005285 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5286 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5287 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5288 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5289 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5290 "option http-tunnel".
5291
5292 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005293 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005294 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5295 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5296 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5297 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5298 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5299 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5300 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005301
5302 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5303 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5304
5305 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5306 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5307 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5308
5309
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005310option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005311no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005312 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5314 yes | yes | yes | no
5315 Arguments : none
5316
5317 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5318 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5319 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5320 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5321 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5322 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5323 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5324
5325 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5326 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
5327 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
5328 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
5329 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
5330 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
5331 request along its whole life.
5332
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005333 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5334 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5335 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5336 front of an existing proxy.
5337
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005338 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5339
5340 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5341 http-server-close".
5342
5343
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005344option httpchk
5345option httpchk <uri>
5346option httpchk <method> <uri>
5347option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5348 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5350 yes | no | yes | yes
5351 Arguments :
5352 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5353 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5354 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5355 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5356 ones.
5357
5358 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5359 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5360 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5361
5362 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5363 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5364 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5365 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5366 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5367
5368 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5369 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5370 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5371 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5372 the lack of any response.
5373
5374 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5375
5376 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5377 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5378 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5379
5380 Examples :
5381 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5382 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5383 backend https_relay
5384 mode tcp
5385 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5386 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5387
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005388 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5389 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5390 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005391
5392
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005393option httpclose
5394no option httpclose
5395 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5397 yes | yes | yes | yes
5398 Arguments : none
5399
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005400 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5401 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5402 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5403 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005404 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005405 "option http-tunnel".
5406
5407 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5408 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5409 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5410 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5411 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5412 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5413 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5414 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005415
5416 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005417 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005418 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5419 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5420 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5421 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5422 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005423
5424 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5425 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005426 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5427 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005428 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5429 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005430
5431 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5432 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5433
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005434 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5435 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005436
5437
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005438option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005439 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5441 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005442 Arguments :
5443 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5444 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5445 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5446 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5447 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005448
5449 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5450 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5451 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5452 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5453 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5454 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5455 ports.
5456
5457 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5458
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005459 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5460 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005462 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005463
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005464
5465option http_proxy
5466no option http_proxy
5467 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5469 yes | yes | yes | yes
5470 Arguments : none
5471
5472 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5473 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5474 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5475 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5476 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5477
5478 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5479 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
5480 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
5481 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01005482 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005483 be analyzed.
5484
5485 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5486 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5487
5488 Example :
5489 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5490 backend direct_forward
5491 option httpclose
5492 option http_proxy
5493
5494 See also : "option httpclose"
5495
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005496
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005497option independent-streams
5498no option independent-streams
5499 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5501 yes | yes | yes | yes
5502 Arguments : none
5503
5504 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5505 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5506 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5507 receive data or not.
5508
5509 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5510 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5511 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5512 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5513 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5514 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5515 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5516 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5517 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5518 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5519 socket buffers.
5520
5521 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5522 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5523 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5524 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5525 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5526
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005527 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005528 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5529 deprecated.
5530
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005531 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005532
5533
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005534option ldap-check
5535 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5537 yes | no | yes | yes
5538 Arguments : none
5539
5540 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5541 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5542 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5543 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5544
5545 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5546 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5547
5548 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5549 configure it.
5550
5551 Example :
5552 option ldap-check
5553
5554 See also : "option httpchk"
5555
5556
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005557option external-check
5558 Use external processes for server health checks
5559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5560 yes | no | yes | yes
5561
5562 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5563 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5564 command".
5565
5566 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5567
5568 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5569
5570
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005571option log-health-checks
5572no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005573 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5575 yes | no | yes | yes
5576 Arguments : none
5577
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005578 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5579 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5580 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005581
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005582 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5583 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5584 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5585 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5586 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5587
5588 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5589 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005590
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005591 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5592 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5593 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005594
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005595
5596option log-separate-errors
5597no option log-separate-errors
5598 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5600 yes | yes | yes | no
5601 Arguments : none
5602
5603 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5604 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5605 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5606 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5607 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5608 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5609 provides very important information.
5610
5611 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5612 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5613 error logs.
5614
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005615 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005616 logging.
5617
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005618
5619option logasap
5620no option logasap
5621 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5623 yes | yes | yes | no
5624 Arguments : none
5625
5626 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5627 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5628 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5629 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5630 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5631 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5632 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005633 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005634 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5635 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5636
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005637 Examples :
5638 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5639 mode http
5640 option httplog
5641 option logasap
5642 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5643
5644 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5645 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5646 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5647 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005649 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005650 logging.
5651
5652
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005653option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005654 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5656 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005657 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005658 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5659 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005660 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005661
5662 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5663 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5664 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5665 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5666 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5667 in the MySQL table, like this :
5668
5669 USE mysql;
5670 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5671 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5672
5673 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5674 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5675 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5676 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5677 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5678 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5679 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5680 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5681 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5682
5683 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5684 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005685
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005686 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005687
5688 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5689 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5690 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5691 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005692 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5693 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005694
5695 See also: "option httpchk"
5696
5697
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005698option nolinger
5699no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005700 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005701 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5702 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005703 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005704
5705 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5706 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5707 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5708 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5709 connections.
5710
5711 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5712 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5713 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5714 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5715 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5716 this too.
5717
5718 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5719 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5720 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5721
5722 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5723 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5724 for servers.
5725
5726 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5727 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5728
5729
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005730option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5731 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5733 yes | yes | yes | yes
5734 Arguments :
5735 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5736 matching <network>
5737 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5738 header name.
5739
5740 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5741 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5742 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5743 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5744 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5745 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5746 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5747 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5748 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5749 possible that the client has already brought one.
5750
5751 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5752 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5753 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5754 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5755 header and requires different one.
5756
5757 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5758 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5759 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5760 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5761 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5762 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5763 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5764
5765 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5766 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5767 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5768 both are defined.
5769
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005770 Examples :
5771 # Original Destination address
5772 frontend www
5773 mode http
5774 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5775
5776 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5777 backend www
5778 mode http
5779 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5780
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005781 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5782 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005783
5784
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005785option persist
5786no option persist
5787 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5788 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5789 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005790 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005791
5792 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5793 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5794 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5795 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5796 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5797 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5798 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5799 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5800 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5801 redirected to another valid server.
5802
5803 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5804 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5805
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005806 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005807
5808
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005809option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5810 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5812 yes | no | yes | yes
5813 Arguments :
5814 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5815 PostgreSQL server.
5816
5817 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5818 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5819 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5820 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5821
5822 See also: "option httpchk"
5823
5824
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005825option prefer-last-server
5826no option prefer-last-server
5827 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5828 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5829 yes | no | yes | yes
5830 Arguments : none
5831
5832 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5833 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5834 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5835 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5836 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5837 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5838 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5839 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5840 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005841 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5842 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5843 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5844 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5845 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5846 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5847 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005848
5849 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5850 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5851
5852 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5853
5854
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005855option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005856option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005857no option redispatch
5858 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5859 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5860 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005861 Arguments :
5862 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5863 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5864 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5865 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5866 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5867 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5868 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5869 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5870 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5871
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005872
5873 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5874 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5875 be able to access the service anymore.
5876
5877 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5878 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5879
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005880 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005881 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5882 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005883
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005884 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5885 "redisp" keywords.
5886
5887 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5888 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5889
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005890 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005891
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005892
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005893option redis-check
5894 Use redis health checks for server testing
5895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5896 yes | no | yes | yes
5897 Arguments : none
5898
5899 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5900 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5901 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5902 find the "+PONG" response message.
5903
5904 Example :
5905 option redis-check
5906
5907 See also : "option httpchk"
5908
5909
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005910option smtpchk
5911option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5912 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5914 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005915 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005916 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5917 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5918 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5919
5920 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5921 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5922 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5923
5924 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5925 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5926 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5927 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5928 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5929 dead server.
5930
5931 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5932 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5933 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5934 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5935
5936 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5937 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5938 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5939 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005940 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005941
5942 Example :
5943 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5944
5945 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005947
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005948option socket-stats
5949no option socket-stats
5950
5951 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5953 yes | yes | yes | no
5954
5955 Arguments : none
5956
5957
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005958option splice-auto
5959no option splice-auto
5960 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5962 yes | yes | yes | yes
5963 Arguments : none
5964
5965 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5966 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5967 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5968 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005969 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005970 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5971 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5972 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5973 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5974
5975 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5976 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5977 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5978 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5979 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5980 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5981 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5982 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5983 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5984 keyword.
5985
5986 Example :
5987 option splice-auto
5988
5989 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5990 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5991
5992 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5993 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5994
5995
5996option splice-request
5997no option splice-request
5998 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6000 yes | yes | yes | yes
6001 Arguments : none
6002
6003 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006004 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006005 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6006 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6007 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6008 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6009
6010 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6011
6012 Example :
6013 option splice-request
6014
6015 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6016 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6017
6018 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6019 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6020
6021
6022option splice-response
6023no option splice-response
6024 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6026 yes | yes | yes | yes
6027 Arguments : none
6028
6029 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006030 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006031 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6032 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6033 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6034 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6035
6036 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6037
6038 Example :
6039 option splice-response
6040
6041 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6042 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6043
6044 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6045 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6046
6047
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006048option srvtcpka
6049no option srvtcpka
6050 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6052 yes | no | yes | yes
6053 Arguments : none
6054
6055 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6056 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6057 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6058 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6059
6060 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6061 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6062 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6063 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6064
6065 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6066 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6067 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6068 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6069 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6070
6071 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6072
6073 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6074 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6075 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6076
6077 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6078 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6079
6080 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6081
6082
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006083option ssl-hello-chk
6084 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6086 yes | no | yes | yes
6087 Arguments : none
6088
6089 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6090 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6091 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6092 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6093 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6094 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6095 hello message.
6096
6097 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6098 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6099 messages, which is appreciable.
6100
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006101 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6102 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6103 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006104
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006105 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6106
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006107
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006108option tcp-check
6109 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6110 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6111 yes | no | yes | yes
6112
6113 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6114 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6115
6116 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6117 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6118 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6119
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006120 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006121 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6122 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6123 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6124 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6125 only.
6126
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006127 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006128 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6129 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6130 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6131 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6132
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006133 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006134 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6135 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006136 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006137 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6138 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6139 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6140 the respective protocols.
6141 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6142 analysed.
6143
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006144 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6145 script.
6146
6147 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6148 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6149 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6150 The "comment" is of course optional.
6151
6152
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006153 Examples :
6154 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6155 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006156 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006157
6158 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6159 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006160 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006161
6162 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6163 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006164 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006165 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006166 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006167 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006168 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006169 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006170 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6171 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006172 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006173 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6174 tcp-check expect string +OK
6175
6176 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6177 (send many headers before analyzing)
6178 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006179 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006180 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6181 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6182 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6183 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006184 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006185
6186
6187 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6188
6189
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006190option tcp-smart-accept
6191no option tcp-smart-accept
6192 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6194 yes | yes | yes | no
6195 Arguments : none
6196
6197 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6198 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6199 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6200 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6201 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6202 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6203
6204 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6205 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6206 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6207 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6208
6209 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6210 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6211 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6212 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6213
6214 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6215 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6216 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6217
6218 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6219 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6220 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6221
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006222 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6223
6224
6225option tcp-smart-connect
6226no option tcp-smart-connect
6227 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6229 yes | no | yes | yes
6230 Arguments : none
6231
6232 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6233 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6234 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6235 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6236 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6237
6238 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6239 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6240 complex.
6241
6242 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6243 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6244 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6245
6246 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6247 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6248
6249 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6250
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006251
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006252option tcpka
6253 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6255 yes | yes | yes | yes
6256 Arguments : none
6257
6258 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6259 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6260 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6261 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6262
6263 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6264 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6265 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6266 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6267
6268 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6269 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6270 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6271 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6272 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6273
6274 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6275
6276 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6277 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6278 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6279 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6280 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6281 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6282 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6283 backends.
6284
6285 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6286
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006287
6288option tcplog
6289 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6291 yes | yes | yes | yes
6292 Arguments : none
6293
6294 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6295 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6296 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6297 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6298 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6299 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6300 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6301 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6302
6303 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006305 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006306
6307
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006308option transparent
6309no option transparent
6310 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006312 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006313 Arguments : none
6314
6315 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6316 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6317 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6318 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6319 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6320 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6321 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6322 appropriate server.
6323
6324 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6325 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6326
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006327 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006328 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006329
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006330
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006331external-check command <command>
6332 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6334 yes | no | yes | yes
6335
6336 Arguments :
6337 <command> is the external command to run
6338
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006339 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6340
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006341 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006342
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006343 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6344 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6345 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6346 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6347 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6348 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006349
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006350 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6351
6352 Environment variables :
6353 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6354 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6355
6356 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6357
6358 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6359
6360 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6361 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6362 for a UNIX socket).
6363
6364 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6365
6366 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6367
6368 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6369
6370 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6371
6372 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6373
6374 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6375 socket).
6376
6377 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6378 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6379
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006380 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6381 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6382 failed.
6383
6384 Example :
6385 external-check command /bin/true
6386
6387 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6388
6389
6390external-check path <path>
6391 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6393 yes | no | yes | yes
6394
6395 Arguments :
6396 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6397
6398 The default path is "".
6399
6400 Example :
6401 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6402
6403 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6404 "external-check command"
6405
6406
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006407persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006408persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006409 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6411 yes | no | yes | yes
6412 Arguments :
6413 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006414 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6415 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006416
6417 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6418 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6419 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6420 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6421 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6422 forwarded to this server.
6423
6424 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6425 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6426 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006427 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006428 a single "listen" section.
6429
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006430 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6431 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6432 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6433
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006434 Example :
6435 listen tse-farm
6436 bind :3389
6437 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6438 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6439 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6440 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6441 persist rdp-cookie
6442 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006443 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006444 balance rdp-cookie
6445 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6446 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6447
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006448 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6449 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006450
6451
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006452rate-limit sessions <rate>
6453 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6455 yes | yes | yes | no
6456 Arguments :
6457 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6458 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6459
6460 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6461 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6462 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6463 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6464 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6465 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6466
6467 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6468 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6469 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6470 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6471
6472 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6473 listen smtp
6474 mode tcp
6475 bind :25
6476 rate-limit sessions 10
6477 server 127.0.0.1:1025
6478
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006479 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6480 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6481 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006482
6483 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6484
6485
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006486redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6487redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6488redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006489 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6491 no | yes | yes | yes
6492
6493 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006494 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006495
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006496 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006497 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006498 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6499 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6500 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006501
6502 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6503 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6504 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6505 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6506 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006507 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6508 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6509 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6510 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006511
6512 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6513 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6514 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6515 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6516 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6517 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006518 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006519 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006520 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6521 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6522 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006523
6524 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006525 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6526 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6527 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006528 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006529 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6530 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6531 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6532 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006533
6534 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6535 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6536
6537 - "drop-query"
6538 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6539 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6540 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6541 with a location-type redirect.
6542
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006543 - "append-slash"
6544 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6545 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6546 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6547 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6548
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006549 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6550 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6551 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6552 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6553 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6554 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6555 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6556
6557 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6558 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6559 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6560 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6561 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6562 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6563 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006564
6565 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6566 acl clear dst_port 80
6567 acl secure dst_port 8080
6568 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006569 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006570 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006571 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6572
6573 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006574 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6575 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6576 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006577 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006578
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006579 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6580 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6581 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6582
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006583 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006584 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006585
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006586 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
6587 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
6588 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
6589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006590 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006591
6592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006593redisp (deprecated)
6594redispatch (deprecated)
6595 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6596 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6597 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006598 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006599
6600 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6601 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6602 be able to access the service anymore.
6603
6604 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6605 redistribute them to a working server.
6606
6607 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6608 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6609 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006611 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6612 "option redispatch" instead.
6613
6614 See also : "option redispatch"
6615
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006616
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006617reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006618 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6620 no | yes | yes | yes
6621 Arguments :
6622 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6623 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006624 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006625
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006626 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6627 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6628
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006629 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6630 the last header of an HTTP request.
6631
6632 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6633 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6634 responses.
6635
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006636 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6637 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6638 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6639
6640 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6641 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006642
6643
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006644reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6645reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006646 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6648 no | yes | yes | yes
6649 Arguments :
6650 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6651 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6652 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6653 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6654 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6655 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6656 ignores case.
6657
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006658 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6659 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6660
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006661 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6662 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6663 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6664 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006665 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006666
6667 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6668 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6669
6670 Example :
6671 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6672 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6673 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6674
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006675 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6676 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006677
6678
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006679reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6680reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006681 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6683 no | yes | yes | yes
6684 Arguments :
6685 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6686 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6687 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6688 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6689 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6690 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6691
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006692 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6693 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6694
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006695 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6696 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6697 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6698 next servers.
6699
6700 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6701 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6702 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6703
6704 Example :
6705 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6706 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6707 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6708
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006709 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6710 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006711
6712
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006713reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6714reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006715 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6717 no | yes | yes | yes
6718 Arguments :
6719 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6720 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6721 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6722 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6723 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6724 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6725 case.
6726
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006727 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6728 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6729
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006730 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6731 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6732 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6733 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006734 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006735
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006736 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006737 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006738 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006739
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006740 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6741 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6742
6743 Example :
6744 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6745 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6746 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6747
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006748 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6749 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006750
6751
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006752reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6753reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006754 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6756 no | yes | yes | yes
6757 Arguments :
6758 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6759 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6760 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6761 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6762 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6763 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6764 case.
6765
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006766 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6767 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6768
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006769 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6770 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6771 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6772 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6773
6774 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6775 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6776
6777 Example :
6778 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6779 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6780 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6781 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6782
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006783 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6784 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006785
6786
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006787reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6788reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006789 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6791 no | yes | yes | yes
6792 Arguments :
6793 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6794 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6795 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6796 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6797 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6798 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6799
6800 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6801 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6802 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6803 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006804 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006805
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006806 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6807 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6808
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006809 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6810 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6811 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6812
6813 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6814 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6815 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6816 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6817 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6818
6819 Example :
6820 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006821 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006822 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6823 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6824
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006825 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6826 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006827
6828
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006829reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6830reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006831 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6833 no | yes | yes | yes
6834 Arguments :
6835 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6836 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6837 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6838 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6839 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6840 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6841 ignores case.
6842
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006843 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6844 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6845
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006846 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6847 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006848 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6849 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6850 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006851 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6852 not set.
6853
6854 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6855 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6856 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6857 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6858 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6859
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006860 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006861 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6862 # block all others.
6863 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6864 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6865
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006866 # block bad guys
6867 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6868 reqitarpit . if badguys
6869
6870 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6871 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006872
6873
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006874retries <value>
6875 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6876 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6877 yes | no | yes | yes
6878 Arguments :
6879 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6880 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6881 default value is 3.
6882
6883 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6884 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6885 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6886
6887 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006888 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6889 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006890
6891 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6892 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6893
6894 See also : "option redispatch"
6895
6896
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006897rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006898 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6900 no | yes | yes | yes
6901 Arguments :
6902 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6903 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006904 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006905
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006906 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6907 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6908
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006909 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6910 the last header of an HTTP response.
6911
6912 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6913 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6914 responses.
6915
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006916 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6917 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006918
6919
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006920rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6921rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006922 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6924 no | yes | yes | yes
6925 Arguments :
6926 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6927 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6928 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6929 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6930 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6931 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6932 ignores case.
6933
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006934 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6935 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6936
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006937 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6938 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006939 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006940 client.
6941
6942 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6943 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6944 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6945
6946 Example :
6947 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006948 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006949
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006950 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6951 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006952
6953
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006954rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6955rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006956 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6958 no | yes | yes | yes
6959 Arguments :
6960 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6961 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6962 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6963 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6964 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6965 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6966 ignores case.
6967
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006968 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6969 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6970
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006971 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6972 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6973 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6974 case-sensitive.
6975
6976 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006977 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6978 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6979 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006980
6981 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6982 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6983
6984 Example :
6985 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6986 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6987
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006988 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6989 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006990
6991
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006992rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6993rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006994 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6996 no | yes | yes | yes
6997 Arguments :
6998 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6999 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7000 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7001 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7002 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7003 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7004 ignores case.
7005
7006 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7007 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7008 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7009 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007010 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007011
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007012 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7013 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7014
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007015 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7016 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7017 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7018
7019 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7020 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7021 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7022 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7023 are not case-sensitive.
7024
7025 Example :
7026 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7027 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7028
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007029 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
7030 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007031
7032
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007033server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007034 Declare a server in a backend
7035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7036 no | no | yes | yes
7037 Arguments :
7038 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007039 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007040 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007041
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007042 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7043 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7044 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7045 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007046 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7047 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7048 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7049 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7050 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007051 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7052 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7053 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7054 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7055 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7056 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7057 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007058 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007059 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7060 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
7061 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007062
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007063 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007064 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7065 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7066 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7067 adding this value to the client's port.
7068
7069 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7070 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007071 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007072
7073 Examples :
7074 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7075 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007076 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007077 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7078 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7079 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007080
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007081 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7082 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7083 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7084 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7085 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7086
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007087 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7088 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007089
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007090server-state-file-name [<file>]
7091 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7092 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7093 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7094 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7095 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7096 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7097
7098 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7099 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7100
7101 global
7102 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7103
7104 backend bk
7105 load-server-state-from-file
7106
7107 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7108 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007109
7110source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007111source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007112source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007113 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7115 yes | no | yes | yes
7116 Arguments :
7117 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7118 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007119
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007120 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007121 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7122 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7123 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7124 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7125 supported prefixes are :
7126 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7127 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7128 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007129 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007130 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7131 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007132
7133 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7134 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007135 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7136 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7137 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007138
7139 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7140 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7141 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7142 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7143 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7144 <addr>.
7145
7146 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7147 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7148 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7149 port.
7150
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007151 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7152 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7153 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7154 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007155 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007156 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7157 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7158 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7159 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7160 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7161 HTTP header.
7162
7163 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7164 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007165 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007166 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7167 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7168 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7169 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7170 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7171 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7172 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7173
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007174 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7175 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7176 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7177 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7178 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7179 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7180
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007181 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7182 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7183 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7184 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7185
7186 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7187 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7188 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7189 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7190 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7191 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7192
7193 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7194 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7195 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7196 there are two methods :
7197
7198 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7199 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7200 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7201 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7202 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7203 of the client ranges may be used.
7204
7205 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7206 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7207 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7208 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7209 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7210 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7211 same session.
7212
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007213 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7214 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7215 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007216 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007217
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007218 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7219
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007220 Examples :
7221 backend private
7222 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7223 source 192.168.1.200
7224
7225 backend transparent_ssl1
7226 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7227 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7228
7229 backend transparent_ssl2
7230 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7231 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7232 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7233
7234 backend transparent_ssl3
7235 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7236 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7237 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7238
7239 backend transparent_smtp
7240 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7241 # with Tproxy version 4.
7242 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7243
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007244 backend transparent_http
7245 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7246 # proxy.
7247 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7248
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007249 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007250 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007252
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007253srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7254 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7256 yes | no | yes | yes
7257 Arguments :
7258 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7259 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7260 as explained at the top of this document.
7261
7262 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7263 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7264 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7265 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7266 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7267 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7268 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7269
7270 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7271 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7272 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7273 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7274 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007275 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007276 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007277 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007278
7279 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7280 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7281 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7282 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7283 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7284 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7285
7286 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7287 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7288
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007289 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7290 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007291
7292
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007293stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7294 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007296 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007297
7298 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7299 matched.
7300
7301 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7302 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7303
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007304 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7305 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7306 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7307
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007308 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7309 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7310 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7311 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007312
7313 Example :
7314 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7315 backend stats_localhost
7316 stats enable
7317 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7318
7319 Example :
7320 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7321 backend stats_auth
7322 stats enable
7323 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7324 stats admin if TRUE
7325
7326 Example :
7327 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7328 userlist stats-auth
7329 group admin users admin
7330 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7331 group readonly users haproxy
7332 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7333
7334 backend stats_auth
7335 stats enable
7336 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7337 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7338 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7339 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7340
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007341 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7342 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7343 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007344
7345
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007346stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7347 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007349 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007350 Arguments :
7351 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7352
7353 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7354
7355 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7356 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7357 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7358 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7359 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7360 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7361
7362 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7363 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7364 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007365 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007366
7367 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7368 report using "stats scope".
7369
7370 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7371 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7372 unobvious parameters.
7373
7374 Example :
7375 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7376 backend public_www
7377 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7378 stats enable
7379 stats hide-version
7380 stats scope .
7381 stats uri /admin?stats
7382 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7383 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7384 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7385
7386 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7387 backend private_monitoring
7388 stats enable
7389 stats uri /admin?stats
7390 stats refresh 5s
7391
7392 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7393
7394
7395stats enable
7396 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007398 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007399 Arguments : none
7400
7401 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7402 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7403 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7404 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7405 - stats auth : no authentication
7406 - stats scope : no restriction
7407
7408 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7409 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7410 unobvious parameters.
7411
7412 Example :
7413 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7414 backend public_www
7415 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7416 stats enable
7417 stats hide-version
7418 stats scope .
7419 stats uri /admin?stats
7420 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7421 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7422 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7423
7424 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7425 backend private_monitoring
7426 stats enable
7427 stats uri /admin?stats
7428 stats refresh 5s
7429
7430 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7431
7432
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007433stats hide-version
7434 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007436 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007437 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007438
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007439 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7440 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7441 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7442 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7443 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7444 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007445
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007446 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7447 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7448 unobvious parameters.
7449
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007450 Example :
7451 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7452 backend public_www
7453 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007454 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007455 stats hide-version
7456 stats scope .
7457 stats uri /admin?stats
7458 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7459 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7460 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007461
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007462 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7463 backend private_monitoring
7464 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007465 stats uri /admin?stats
7466 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007467
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007468 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007469
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007470
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007471stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7472 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7473 Access control for statistics
7474
7475 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7476 no | no | yes | yes
7477
7478 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7479 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7480 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7481 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7482 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7483 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7484
7485 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7486 instance.
7487
7488 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7489 about ACL usage.
7490
7491
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007492stats realm <realm>
7493 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007495 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007496 Arguments :
7497 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7498 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7499 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7500
7501 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7502 using a backslash ('\').
7503
7504 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7505 only related to authentication.
7506
7507 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7508 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7509 unobvious parameters.
7510
7511 Example :
7512 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7513 backend public_www
7514 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7515 stats enable
7516 stats hide-version
7517 stats scope .
7518 stats uri /admin?stats
7519 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7520 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7521 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7522
7523 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7524 backend private_monitoring
7525 stats enable
7526 stats uri /admin?stats
7527 stats refresh 5s
7528
7529 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7530
7531
7532stats refresh <delay>
7533 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007535 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007536 Arguments :
7537 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7538 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7539 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7540 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7541 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7542 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7543
7544 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7545 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7546 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7547 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7548
7549 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7550 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7551 unobvious parameters.
7552
7553 Example :
7554 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7555 backend public_www
7556 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7557 stats enable
7558 stats hide-version
7559 stats scope .
7560 stats uri /admin?stats
7561 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7562 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7563 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7564
7565 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7566 backend private_monitoring
7567 stats enable
7568 stats uri /admin?stats
7569 stats refresh 5s
7570
7571 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7572
7573
7574stats scope { <name> | "." }
7575 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007577 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007578 Arguments :
7579 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7580 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7581 section in which the statement appears.
7582
7583 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7584 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7585 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7586 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7587 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7588 exists.
7589
7590 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7591 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7592 unobvious parameters.
7593
7594 Example :
7595 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7596 backend public_www
7597 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7598 stats enable
7599 stats hide-version
7600 stats scope .
7601 stats uri /admin?stats
7602 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7603 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7604 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7605
7606 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7607 backend private_monitoring
7608 stats enable
7609 stats uri /admin?stats
7610 stats refresh 5s
7611
7612 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7613
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007614
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007615stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007616 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007618 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007619
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007620 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007621 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7622
7623 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7624 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7625
7626 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7627 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007628 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007629
7630 Example :
7631 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7632 backend private_monitoring
7633 stats enable
7634 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7635 stats uri /admin?stats
7636 stats refresh 5s
7637
7638 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7639 global section.
7640
7641
7642stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007643 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7645 yes | yes | yes | yes
7646 Arguments : none
7647
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007648 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007649 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7650 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7651 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7652 - IP (socket, server)
7653 - cookie (backend, server)
7654
7655 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7656 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007657 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007658
7659 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7660
7661
7662stats show-node [ <name> ]
7663 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007665 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007666 Arguments:
7667 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7668 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7669
7670 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7671 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007672 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007673
7674 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7675 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7676 unobvious parameters.
7677
7678 Example:
7679 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7680 backend private_monitoring
7681 stats enable
7682 stats show-node Europe-1
7683 stats uri /admin?stats
7684 stats refresh 5s
7685
7686 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7687 section.
7688
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007689
7690stats uri <prefix>
7691 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007693 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007694 Arguments :
7695 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7696 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7697 query string.
7698
7699 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7700 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7701 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7702 possible to reach it in the application.
7703
7704 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007705 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007706 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7707 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7708 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7709 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7710
7711 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7712 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7713 an address or a port to statistics only.
7714
7715 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7716 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7717 unobvious parameters.
7718
7719 Example :
7720 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7721 backend public_www
7722 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7723 stats enable
7724 stats hide-version
7725 stats scope .
7726 stats uri /admin?stats
7727 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7728 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7729 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7730
7731 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7732 backend private_monitoring
7733 stats enable
7734 stats uri /admin?stats
7735 stats refresh 5s
7736
7737 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7738
7739
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007740stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7741 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007743 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007744
7745 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007746 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007747 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7748 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7749 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7750
7751 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7752 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7753 the "stick-table" statement.
7754
7755 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7756 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7757 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7758 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7759 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7760
7761 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7762 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7763 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7764 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7765 transformation rules.
7766
7767 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7768 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7769 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7770 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7771 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7772 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7773 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7774
7775 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7776 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7777 ACL based conditions.
7778
7779 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7780 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7781 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7782 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7783
7784 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7785 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7786 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7787 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7788
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007789 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7790 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7791 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7792
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007793 Example :
7794 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7795 # last 30 minutes
7796 backend pop
7797 mode tcp
7798 balance roundrobin
7799 stick store-request src
7800 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7801 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7802 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7803
7804 backend smtp
7805 mode tcp
7806 balance roundrobin
7807 stick match src table pop
7808 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7809 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7810
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007811 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007812 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007813
7814
7815stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7816 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7818 no | no | yes | yes
7819
7820 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7821 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7822 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7823 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7824
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007825 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7826 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7827 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7828
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007829 Examples :
7830 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007831 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007832
7833 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7834 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7835 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7836
7837
7838 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7839 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7840 backend http
7841 mode http
7842 balance roundrobin
7843 stick on src table https
7844 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7845 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7846 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7847
7848 backend https
7849 mode tcp
7850 balance roundrobin
7851 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7852 stick on src
7853 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7854 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7855
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007856 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007857
7858
7859stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7860 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7862 no | no | yes | yes
7863
7864 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007865 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007866 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7867 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7868 server is selected.
7869
7870 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7871 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7872 the "stick-table" statement.
7873
7874 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7875 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7876 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7877 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7878 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7879 address.
7880
7881 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7882 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7883 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7884 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7885 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7886 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7887 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7888 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7889 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7890 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7891
7892 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7893 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7894 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7895 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7896 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7897 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7898 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7899
7900 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7901 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7902 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7903 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7904
7905 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7906 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7907 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7908 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7909 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7910 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007911 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7912 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7913 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7914 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7915 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7916 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007917
7918 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7919 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7920 the request.
7921
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007922 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7923 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7924 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7925
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007926 Example :
7927 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7928 # last 30 minutes
7929 backend pop
7930 mode tcp
7931 balance roundrobin
7932 stick store-request src
7933 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7934 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7935 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7936
7937 backend smtp
7938 mode tcp
7939 balance roundrobin
7940 stick match src table pop
7941 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7942 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7943
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007944 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007945 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007946
7947
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007948stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007949 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7950 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007951 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007953 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007954
7955 Arguments :
7956 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7957 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7958 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7959 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7960
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007961 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7962 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7963 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7964 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7965
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007966 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7967 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7968 instance.
7969
7970 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7971 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7972 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7973 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7974 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7975 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007976 to 32 characters.
7977
7978 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7979 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7980 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007981 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007982 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7983 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007984
7985 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007986 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7987 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007988 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7989 increase.
7990
7991 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007992 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7993 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7994 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007995
7996 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7997 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7998 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7999 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8000 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8001 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8002 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8003 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8004 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8005 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8006 parameter (see below).
8007
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008008 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8009 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8010 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8011 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8012 soft restart.
8013
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008014 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8015 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008016
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008017 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8018 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8019 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8020 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8021 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008022 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008023 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8024 if not expiration delay is specified.
8025
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008026 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8027 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8028 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8029 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008030 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8031 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8032 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8033 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8034 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8035 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8036 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8037 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8038 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8039 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8040 types and their arguments.
8041
8042 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8043 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8044 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8045 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8046
8047 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8048 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8049 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8050 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8051
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008052 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8053 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8054 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8055 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8056 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8057 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8058
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008059 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8060 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8061 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8062 they were received.
8063
8064 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8065 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8066 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8067 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8068 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8069
8070 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8071 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8072 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8073 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8074 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8075
8076 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8077 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8078 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8079
8080 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8081 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8082 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8083 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8084 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8085
8086 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8087 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8088 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8089 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8090 the client side.
8091
8092 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8093 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8094 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8095 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8096 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8097 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8098 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8099
8100 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8101 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8102 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8103 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8104 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8105 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8106 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8107
8108 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8109 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8110 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8111 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8112 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8113 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8114
8115 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8116 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8117 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8118 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8119
8120 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8121 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8122 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8123 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8124 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8125 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8126 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8127 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8128 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8129 recommended for better fairness.
8130
8131 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8132 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8133 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8134 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8135
8136 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8137 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8138 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8139 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8140 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8141 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8142 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8143 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8144 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8145 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008146
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008147 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8148 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008149 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8150 reference it.
8151
8152 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8153 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
8154 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
8155 as an exclusive stickiness.
8156
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008157 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8158 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8159 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8160 something that can be ignored.
8161
8162 Example:
8163 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8164 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8165 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8166 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8167
8168 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008169 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008170
8171
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008172stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8173 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8175 no | no | yes | yes
8176
8177 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008178 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008179 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8180 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8181 server is selected.
8182
8183 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8184 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8185 the "stick-table" statement.
8186
8187 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8188 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8189 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8190 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8191
8192 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8193 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8194 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8195 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8196 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8197 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008198 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008199 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8200 rules.
8201
8202 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8203 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8204 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8205 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8206 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8207 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8208 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8209
8210 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8211 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8212 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8213 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8214
8215 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8216 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8217 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8218 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8219 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8220 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008221 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8222 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8223 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8224 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8225 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8226 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8227 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8228 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8229 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008230
8231 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8232
8233 Example :
8234 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8235 backend https
8236 mode tcp
8237 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008238 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008239 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008240
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008241 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8242 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8243
8244 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8245 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8246 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8247
8248 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8249 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008250
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008251 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8252 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8253 # at offset 44.
8254
8255 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8256 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8257
8258 # Learn on response if server hello.
8259 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008260
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008261 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8262 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8263
8264 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8265 extraction.
8266
8267
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008268tcp-check connect [params*]
8269 Opens a new connection
8270 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8271 no | no | yes | yes
8272
8273 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8274 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8275 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8276
8277 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8278 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8279 of the sequence.
8280
8281 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8282 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8283 do.
8284
8285 Parameters :
8286 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8287 use the TCP connection.
8288
8289 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8290 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8291 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8292
8293 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8294
8295 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8296
8297 Examples:
8298 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8299 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8300 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8301 option tcp-check
8302 tcp-check connect
8303 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8304 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8305 tcp-check send \r\n
8306 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8307 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8308 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8309 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8310 tcp-check send \r\n
8311 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8312 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8313
8314 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8315 option tcp-check
8316 tcp-check connect port 110
8317 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8318 tcp-check connect port 143
8319 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8320 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8321
8322 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8323
8324
8325tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8326 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8327 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8328 no | no | yes | yes
8329
8330 Arguments :
8331 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8332 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8333 binary.
8334 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8335 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8336 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8337
8338 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8339 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8340 with the usual backslash ('\').
8341 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8342 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8343 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8344 used upper or lower case.
8345
8346
8347 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8348
8349 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8350 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8351 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8352 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8353 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8354 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8355 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8356 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8357
8358 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8359 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8360 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8361 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8362 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8363 expression.
8364
8365 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8366 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8367 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8368 this exact hexadecimal string.
8369 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8370
8371 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8372 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8373 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8374 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8375 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8376 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8377 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8378 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8379 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8380 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8381 the null character.
8382
8383 Examples :
8384 # perform a POP check
8385 option tcp-check
8386 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8387
8388 # perform an IMAP check
8389 option tcp-check
8390 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8391
8392 # look for the redis master server
8393 option tcp-check
8394 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008395 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008396 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8397 tcp-check expect string role:master
8398 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8399 tcp-check expect string +OK
8400
8401
8402 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8403 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8404
8405
8406tcp-check send <data>
8407 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8408 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8409 no | no | yes | yes
8410
8411 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8412 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8413
8414 Examples :
8415 # look for the redis master server
8416 option tcp-check
8417 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8418 tcp-check expect string role:master
8419
8420 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8421 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8422
8423
8424tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8425 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8426 tcp health check
8427 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8428 no | no | yes | yes
8429
8430 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8431 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8432 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8433 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8434 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8435 hexadecimal string.
8436 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8437
8438 Examples :
8439 # redis check in binary
8440 option tcp-check
8441 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8442 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8443
8444
8445 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8446 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8447
8448
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008449tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8450 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8452 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008453 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008454 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8455 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008456
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008457 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008458
8459 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8460 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008461 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8462 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8463 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8464 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8465 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8466 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008467
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008468 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8469 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8470 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8471 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008472
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008473 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008474 - accept :
8475 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8476 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8477 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008478
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008479 - reject :
8480 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8481 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8482 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8483 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8484 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8485 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8486 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8487 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8488 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8489 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8490 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8491 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008492
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008493 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8494 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8495 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8496 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8497 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8498 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8499 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8500 hosts.
8501
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008502 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8503 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8504 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8505 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8506 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8507 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8508 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8509 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8510 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008511 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8512 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008513
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008514 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008515 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008516 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008517 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008518 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8519 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008520 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008521 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8522 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8523 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8524 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8525 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008526
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008527 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008528 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008529 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008530 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8531 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8532 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8533 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008534
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008535 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8536 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8537 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8538 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008539
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008540 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8541 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8542 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8543 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8544 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008545 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8546 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8547 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8548 layer7 information is extracted.
8549
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008550 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8551 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8552 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8553 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8554 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008555
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008556 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8557 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8558 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8559 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8560
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008561 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8562 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8563 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8564 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8565 continues.
8566
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008567 - "silent-drop" :
8568 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8569 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8570 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8571 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8572 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8573 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8574 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8575 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8576 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8577 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8578 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8579 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8580 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8581 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8582 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8583 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8584
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008585 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8586 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8587 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008588
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008589 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8590 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8591 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008592
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008593 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008594 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008595 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008596
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008597 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8598 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8599 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008600
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008601 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008602 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8603 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008604
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008605 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8606
8607 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8608
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008609 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8610
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008611 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008612
8613
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008614tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8615 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008617 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008618 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008619 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8620 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008621
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008622 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008623
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008624 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8625 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8626 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8627 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8628 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008629
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008630 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8631 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8632 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8633 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008634 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8635 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8636 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8637 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8638 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8639 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008640 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008641 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008642
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008643 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8644 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8645 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8646 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008647
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008648 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008649 - accept : the request is accepted
8650 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8651 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008652 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008653 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008654 - set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008655 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008656 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008657
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008658 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8659 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008660
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008661 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8662 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8663 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8664 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8665 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8666 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008668 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008669 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8670 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008671
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008672 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008673 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8674 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8675 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8676 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008677 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8678 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8679 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008680
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008681 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008682 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8683 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8684 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008685
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008686 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8687 declared inline.
8688
8689 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8690 The allowed scopes are:
8691 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8692 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8693 (request and response)
8694 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8695 processing
8696 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8697 processing.
8698 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8699 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8700
8701 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8702 followed by some converters.
8703
8704 Example:
8705
8706 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8707
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008708 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008709 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8710 # and reject everything else.
8711 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8712 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008713 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008714 tcp-request content reject
8715
8716 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008717 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8718 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8719 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008720 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008721
8722 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8723 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8724 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008725 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008726 tcp-request content reject
8727
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008728 Example:
8729 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8730 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008731 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008732
8733 Example:
8734 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8735 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008736 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008737
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008738 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8739 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8740
8741 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008742 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008743 # protecting all our sites
8744 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008745 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8746 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008747 ...
8748 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8749
8750 backend http_dynamic
8751 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008752 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008753 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008754 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8755 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8756 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008757 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008759 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008760
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008761 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008762
8763
8764tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8765 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008767 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008768 Arguments :
8769 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8770 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8771 as explained at the top of this document.
8772
8773 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8774 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8775 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8776 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8777 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8778
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008779 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8780 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8781 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8782 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8783
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008784 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8785 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008786 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008787 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008788 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8789 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8790 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8791 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008792
8793 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8794 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8795 it pass through unaffected.
8796
8797 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8798 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8799 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008800 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008801 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8802 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008803 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8804 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8805 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008806
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008807 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008808 "timeout client".
8809
8810
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008811tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8812 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8814 no | no | yes | yes
8815 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008816 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8817 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008818
8819 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8820
8821 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8822 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8823 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008824 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8825 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008826
8827 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8828
8829 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8830 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8831 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8832 inserted.
8833
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008834 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008835 - accept :
8836 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8837 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8838 the rules evaluation.
8839
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008840 - close :
8841 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8842 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8843 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8844 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8845 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8846 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008847 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008848 protocols.
8849
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008850 - reject :
8851 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8852 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008853 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008854
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008855 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
8856 Sets a variable.
8857
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008858 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8859 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8860 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
8861 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
8862
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008863 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
8864 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8865 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8866 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8867 continues.
8868
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008869 - "silent-drop" :
8870 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8871 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8872 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8873 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8874 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8875 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8876 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8877 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8878 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8879 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8880 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8881 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8882 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8883 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8884 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8885 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8886
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008887 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8888 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8889 for changing the default action to a reject.
8890
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008891 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8892 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8893 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8894 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008895 period.
8896
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008897 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8898 declared inline.
8899
8900 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8901 The allowed scopes are:
8902 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8903 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8904 (request and response)
8905 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8906 processing
8907 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8908 processing.
8909 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8910 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8911
8912 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8913 followed by some converters.
8914
8915 Example:
8916
8917 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8918
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008919 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8920
8921 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8922
8923
8924tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8925 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8927 no | no | yes | yes
8928 Arguments :
8929 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8930 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8931 as explained at the top of this document.
8932
8933 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8934
8935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008936timeout check <timeout>
8937 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8938 established.
8939
8940 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8941 yes | no | yes | yes
8942 Arguments:
8943 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8944 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8945 as explained at the top of this document.
8946
8947 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8948 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8949 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8950 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008951 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8952 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8953 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008954
8955 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8956 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8957
8958 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8959 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008960 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008961
8962 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8963 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8964 forget about it.
8965
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008966 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8967 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008968
8969
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008970timeout client <timeout>
8971timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8972 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8974 yes | yes | yes | no
8975 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008976 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008977 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8978 as explained at the top of this document.
8979
8980 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8981 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8982 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8983 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8984 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8985 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8986 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8987 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008988 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008989 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008990 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8991 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008992 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8993 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008994
8995 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8996 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8997 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8998 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8999 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9000 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9001
9002 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9003 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9004 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9005
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009006 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009007
9008
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009009timeout client-fin <timeout>
9010 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9012 yes | yes | yes | no
9013 Arguments :
9014 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9015 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9016 as explained at the top of this document.
9017
9018 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9019 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9020 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9021 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9022 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9023 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9024 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9025 down in one direction.
9026
9027 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9028 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9029 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9030
9031 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9032
9033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009034timeout connect <timeout>
9035timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9036 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9038 yes | no | yes | yes
9039 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009040 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009041 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9042 as explained at the top of this document.
9043
9044 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009045 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009046 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009047 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009048 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9049 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009050
9051 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9052 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9053 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9054 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9055 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9056 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9057
9058 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9059 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9060 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9061
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009062 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9063 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009064
9065
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009066timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9067 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9069 yes | yes | yes | yes
9070 Arguments :
9071 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9072 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9073 as explained at the top of this document.
9074
9075 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9076 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9077 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9078 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9079 once the request has started to present itself.
9080
9081 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9082 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9083 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9084 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9085 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9086
9087 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9088 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9089 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9090 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9091
9092 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9093 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9094 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9095 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9096 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009097 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009098
9099 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9100 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9101 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9102 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9103
9104 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9105
9106
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009107timeout http-request <timeout>
9108 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009110 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009111 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009112 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009113 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9114 as explained at the top of this document.
9115
9116 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9117 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9118 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9119 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9120 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9121 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9122 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009123 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9124 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9125 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9126 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9127 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009128 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9129 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009130
9131 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
9132 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009133 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
9134 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009135
9136 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9137 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9138 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9139 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9140 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9141
9142 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009143 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9144 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9145 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009146
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009147 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
9148 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009149
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009150
9151timeout queue <timeout>
9152 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9154 yes | no | yes | yes
9155 Arguments :
9156 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9157 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9158 as explained at the top of this document.
9159
9160 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9161 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9162 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9163 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9164 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9165
9166 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9167 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9168 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9169 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9170
9171 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9172
9173
9174timeout server <timeout>
9175timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9176 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9178 yes | no | yes | yes
9179 Arguments :
9180 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9181 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9182 as explained at the top of this document.
9183
9184 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9185 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9186 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9187 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9188 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9189 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9190 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9191
9192 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9193 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9194 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9195 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9196 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009197 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009198 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009199 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9200 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9201 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9202 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009203
9204 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9205 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9206 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9207 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9208 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9209 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9210
9211 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9212 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9213 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9214
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009215 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009216
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009217
9218timeout server-fin <timeout>
9219 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9221 yes | no | yes | yes
9222 Arguments :
9223 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9224 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9225 as explained at the top of this document.
9226
9227 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9228 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9229 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9230 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9231 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9232 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9233 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9234 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9235 situations, it should not be needed.
9236
9237 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9238 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9239 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9240
9241 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9242
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009243
9244timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009245 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9247 yes | yes | yes | yes
9248 Arguments :
9249 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9250 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9251 as explained at the top of this document.
9252
9253 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9254 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9255 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9256
9257 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9258 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9259 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9260 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009261 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009262
9263 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9264
9265
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009266timeout tunnel <timeout>
9267 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9269 yes | no | yes | yes
9270 Arguments :
9271 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9272 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9273 as explained at the top of this document.
9274
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009275 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009276 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9277 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9278 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9279 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9280 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9281 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9282 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9283 specified.
9284
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009285 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9286 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9287 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9288 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9289 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9290 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9291 state.
9292
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009293 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9294 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9295 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9296 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9297 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9298
9299 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9300 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9301 forget about it.
9302
9303 Example :
9304 defaults http
9305 option http-server-close
9306 timeout connect 5s
9307 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009308 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009309 timeout server 30s
9310 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9311
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009312 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009313
9314
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009315transparent (deprecated)
9316 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009318 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009319 Arguments : none
9320
9321 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9322 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9323 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9324 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9325 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9326 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9327 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9328 appropriate server.
9329
9330 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9331
9332 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9333 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9334
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009335 See also: "option transparent"
9336
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009337unique-id-format <string>
9338 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9340 yes | yes | yes | no
9341 Arguments :
9342 <string> is a log-format string.
9343
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009344 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9345 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9346 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9347 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009348
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009349 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9350 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9351 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9352 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9353 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9354 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9355 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9356 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009357
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009358 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9359 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009360
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009361 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009362
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009363 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009364
9365 will generate:
9366
9367 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9368
9369 See also: "unique-id-header"
9370
9371unique-id-header <name>
9372 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9374 yes | yes | yes | no
9375 Arguments :
9376 <name> is the name of the header.
9377
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009378 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9379 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009380
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009381 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009382
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009383 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009384 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9385
9386 will generate:
9387
9388 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9389
9390 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009391
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009392use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009393 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9395 no | yes | yes | no
9396 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009397 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9398 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009399
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009400 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9401 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009402
9403 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9404 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9405 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009406 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9407 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9408 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9409 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009410
9411 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9412 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9413 assign the backend.
9414
9415 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9416 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9417 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9418 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9419 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9420 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9421
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009422 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009423 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009424 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9425 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9426 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9427
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009428 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9429 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9430 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9431 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9432 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9433 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9434 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9435 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9436 cannot be forced from the request.
9437
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009438 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009439 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9440 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9441
9442 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9443 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009444
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009445
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009446use-server <server> if <condition>
9447use-server <server> unless <condition>
9448 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9450 no | no | yes | yes
9451 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009452 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009453
9454 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9455
9456 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9457 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9458 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9459
9460 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9461 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9462 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9463 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9464 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9465 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9466 matches will assign the server.
9467
9468 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9469 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9470 with the next rules until one matches.
9471
9472 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9473 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9474 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9475 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9476
9477 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9478 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9479 stripped.
9480
9481 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9482 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9483 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9484 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9485
9486 Example :
9487 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9488 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9489 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9490 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9491 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9492 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9493 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9494 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9495 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9496
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009497 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009498
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009499
95005. Bind and Server options
9501--------------------------
9502
9503The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9504depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9505settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9506written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9507described in this section.
9508
9509
95105.1. Bind options
9511-----------------
9512
9513The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9514as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9515no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9516parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9517while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9518provided immediately after the setting name.
9519
9520The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9521
9522accept-proxy
9523 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009524 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9525 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009526 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9527 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9528 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9529 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9530 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9531 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9532 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009533 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9534 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009535
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009536alpn <protocols>
9537 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9538 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9539 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9540 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9541 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9542 initial NPN extension.
9543
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009544backlog <backlog>
9545 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9546 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9547
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009548ecdhe <named curve>
9549 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009550 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9551 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009552
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009553ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009554 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9555 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9556 client's certificate.
9557
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009558ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9559 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9560 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9561 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9562 error is ignored.
9563
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009564ca-sign-file <cafile>
9565 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9566 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9567 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9568 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9569 'generate-certificates' for details.
9570
9571ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9572 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9573 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9574 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9575 'generate-certificates' for details.
9576
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009577ciphers <ciphers>
9578 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9579 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009580 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009581 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9582 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9583
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009584crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9586 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9587 to verify client's certificate.
9588
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009589crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009590 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9591 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9592 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9593 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9594 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9595 file.
9596
9597 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9598 are loaded.
9599
9600 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009601 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009602 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9603 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9604 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9605 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9606 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9607 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9608 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009609
9610 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9611 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9612 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9613 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009614 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9615 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009616
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009617 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009618
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009619 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9620 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009621 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009622 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9623 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9624 clients).
9625
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009626 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9627 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9628 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9629 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9630 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9631 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9632 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9633 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9634 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9635 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9636 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9637 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9638 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9639
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009640 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9641 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9642 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9643 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9644 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9645
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009646crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009647 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9648 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009649 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009650 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009651
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009652crt-list <file>
9653 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009654 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9655 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009656
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009657 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009658
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009659 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9660 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9661 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9662 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9663 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9664 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9665 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9666 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009667
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009668defer-accept
9669 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9670 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9671 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9672 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9673 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9674 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9675 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9676 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9677 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9678 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9679 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9680
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009681force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009682 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009683 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009684 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9685 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009686
9687force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009688 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009689 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9690 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009691
9692force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009693 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009694 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9695 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009696
9697force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009698 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009699 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9700 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009701
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009702generate-certificates
9703 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9704 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9705 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9706 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
9707 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
9708 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
9709 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
9710 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
9711 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
9712 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
9713 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
9714
9715 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
9716 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
9717 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
9718 certificate is used many times.
9719
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009720gid <gid>
9721 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9722 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9723 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9724 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9725 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9726
9727group <group>
9728 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9729 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9730 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9731 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9732 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9733
9734id <id>
9735 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9736 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9737 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9738 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9739
9740interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009741 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9742 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9743 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9744 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9745 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9746 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9747 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009748
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009749level <level>
9750 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9751 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9752 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9753 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9754 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9755 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9756 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9757 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9758 counters).
9759 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9760 all counters).
9761
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009762maxconn <maxconn>
9763 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9764 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9765 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9766 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9767 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9768 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9769 eat all memory.
9770
9771mode <mode>
9772 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9773 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9774 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9775 UNIX sockets.
9776
9777mss <maxseg>
9778 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9779 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9780 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9781 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9782 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9783 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9784 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9785 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9786 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9787 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9788 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9789
9790name <name>
9791 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9792 page.
9793
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +02009794namespace <name>
9795 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
9796 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
9797 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
9798 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
9799
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009800nice <nice>
9801 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9802 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9803 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9804 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9805 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9806 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9807 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9808 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9809 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9810 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9811 one for an RDP socket.
9812
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009813no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009814 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009815 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009816 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009817 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9818 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009819 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009820
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009821no-tls-tickets
9822 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9823 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9824 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009825 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9826 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009827
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009828no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009830 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009831 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009832 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9833 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9834 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009835
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009836no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009837 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009838 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009839 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009840 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9841 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9842 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009843
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009844no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009845 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009846 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009847 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009848 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9849 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9850 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009851
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009852npn <protocols>
9853 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9854 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9855 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9856 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009857 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9858 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009859
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009860process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9861 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9862 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9863 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9864 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9865 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9866 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9867 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009868 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9869 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9870 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9871 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9872 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9873 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9874 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009875
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009876ssl
9877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009878 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009879 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9880 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9881 to deciphered contents.
9882
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009883strict-sni
9884 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9885 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9886 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9887 See the "crt" option for more information.
9888
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009889tcp-ut <delay>
9890 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9891 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9892 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9893 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9894 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9895 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9896 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9897 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9898 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9899 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9900 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9901
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009902tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009903 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009904 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9905 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9906 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9907 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9908 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9909 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9910 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009911 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9912 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9913 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009914
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009915tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9916 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9917 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9918 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9919 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9920 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9921 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9922 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9923 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9924 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9925 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9926
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009927transparent
9928 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9929 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9930 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9931 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9932 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9933 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9934 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9935 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9936 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9937 so check for support with your vendor.
9938
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009939v4v6
9940 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9941 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9942 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9943 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009944 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009945
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009946v6only
9947 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9948 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9949 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009950 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9951 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009952
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009953uid <uid>
9954 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9955 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9956 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9957 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9958 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9959
9960user <user>
9961 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9962 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9963 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9964 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9965 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9966
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009967verify [none|optional|required]
9968 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9969 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9970 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9971 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9972 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009973 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9974 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9975 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9976 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009977
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020099785.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009979------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009981The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9982which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9983arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9984settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9985after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9986Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9987address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009989 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009990 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009992The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009993
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009994addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009995 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9996 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9997 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9998 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9999 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010000
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010001 Supported in default-server: No
10002
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010003agent-check
10004 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010005 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10006 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10007 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10008 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010009
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010010 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010011 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010012 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10013 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10014 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010015
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010016 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10017 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010018
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010019 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10020 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10021 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010022
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010023 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10024 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10025 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010026
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010027 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10028 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10029 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10030 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10031 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10032 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10033 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010034
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010035 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10036 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010037
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010038 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10039 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10040 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10041 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10042 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10043 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10044 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10045 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10046 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010047
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010048 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10049 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010050 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10051 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10052 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
10053 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010054
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010055 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10056 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010057
10058 Supported in default-server: No
10059
10060agent-inter <delay>
10061 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10062 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10063
10064 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10065 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10066 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10067 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10068 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10069 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10070 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10071 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10072 of backends use the same servers.
10073
10074 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10075
10076 Supported in default-server: Yes
10077
10078agent-port <port>
10079 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10080
10081 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10082
10083 Supported in default-server: Yes
10084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010085backup
10086 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10087 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10088 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10089 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10090 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10091 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010093 Supported in default-server: No
10094
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010095ca-file <cafile>
10096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10097 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10098 server's certificate.
10099
10100 Supported in default-server: No
10101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010102check
10103 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010104 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10105 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10106 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10107 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10108 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10109 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10110 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010111 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10112 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10113 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010115 Supported in default-server: No
10116
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010117check-send-proxy
10118 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10119 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10120 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10121 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10122 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10123 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10124 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10125
10126 Supported in default-server: No
10127
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010128check-ssl
10129 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10130 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10131 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10132 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010133 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010134 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10135 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10136 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10137 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10138
10139 Supported in default-server: No
10140
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010141ciphers <ciphers>
10142 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010143 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010144 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10145 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10146 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10147 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10148 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10149 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10150
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010151 Supported in default-server: No
10152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010153cookie <value>
10154 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10155 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10156 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10157 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10158 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10159 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10160 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010162 Supported in default-server: No
10163
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010164crl-file <crlfile>
10165 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10166 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10167 to verify server's certificate.
10168
10169 Supported in default-server: No
10170
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010171crt <cert>
10172 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10173 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10174 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10175 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10176 certificate request.
10177
10178 Supported in default-server: No
10179
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010180disabled
10181 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10182 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10183 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10184 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10185 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10186
10187 Supported in default-server: No
10188
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010189error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010190 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10191 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10192 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010193
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010194 Supported in default-server: Yes
10195
10196 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010197
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010198fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010199 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10200 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10201 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010203 Supported in default-server: Yes
10204
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010205force-sslv3
10206 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10207 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010208 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10209 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010210
10211 Supported in default-server: No
10212
10213force-tlsv10
10214 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010215 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10216 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010217
10218 Supported in default-server: No
10219
10220force-tlsv11
10221 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010222 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10223 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010224
10225 Supported in default-server: No
10226
10227force-tlsv12
10228 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010229 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10230 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010231
10232 Supported in default-server: No
10233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010234id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010235 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10236 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10237 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010238
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010239 Supported in default-server: No
10240
10241inter <delay>
10242fastinter <delay>
10243downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010244 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10245 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10246 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10247 between checks depending on the server state :
10248
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010249 Server state | Interval used
10250 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10251 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10252 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10253 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10254 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10255 or yet unchecked. |
10256 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10257 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10258 | "inter" otherwise.
10259 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010261 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10262 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10263 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10264 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010265 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10266 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10267 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10268 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10269 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010271 Supported in default-server: Yes
10272
10273maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010274 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10275 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10276 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10277 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10278 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10279 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10280 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10281 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010283 Supported in default-server: Yes
10284
10285maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010286 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10287 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10288 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10289 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10290 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10291 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10292 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10293
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010294 Supported in default-server: Yes
10295
10296minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010297 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10298 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10299 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10300 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10301 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10302 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010303 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010304 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010305
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010306 Supported in default-server: Yes
10307
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010308namespace <name>
10309 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10310 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10311 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10312 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10313
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010314no-ssl-reuse
10315 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10316 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10317 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10318 and for paranoid users.
10319
10320 Supported in default-server: No
10321
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010322no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010323 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10324 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010325 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010326
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010327 Supported in default-server: No
10328
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010329no-tls-tickets
10330 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10331 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10332 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010333 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10334 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010335
10336 Supported in default-server: No
10337
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010338no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010339 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010340 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10341 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010342 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10343 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10344 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010345
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010346 Supported in default-server: No
10347
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010348no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010349 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010350 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10351 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010352 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10353 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10354 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010355
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010356 Supported in default-server: No
10357
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010358no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010359 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010360 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10361 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010362 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10363 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10364 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010365
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010366 Supported in default-server: No
10367
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010368non-stick
10369 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10370 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10371 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10372
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010373 Supported in default-server: No
10374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010375observe <mode>
10376 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10377 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10378 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10379 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10380 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10381 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010382 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010383
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010384 Supported in default-server: No
10385
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010386 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010388on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010389 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10390 Currently, four modes are available:
10391 - fastinter: force fastinter
10392 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10393 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10394 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10395 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010397 Supported in default-server: Yes
10398
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010399 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10400
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010401on-marked-down <action>
10402 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10403 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010404 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10405 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10406 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10407 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10408 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10409 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10410 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10411 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010412
10413 Actions are disabled by default
10414
10415 Supported in default-server: Yes
10416
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010417on-marked-up <action>
10418 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10419 Currently one action is available:
10420 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10421 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10422 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10423 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10424 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10425 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10426 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10427 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10428
10429 Actions are disabled by default
10430
10431 Supported in default-server: Yes
10432
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010433port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010434 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10435 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10436 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10437 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10438 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10439 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10440
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010441 Supported in default-server: Yes
10442
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010443redir <prefix>
10444 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10445 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10446 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10447 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10448 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10449 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10450 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10451 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010452 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010453 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10454 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10455 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10456 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10457 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10458
10459 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10460
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010461 Supported in default-server: No
10462
10463rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010464 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10465 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10466 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10467
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010468 Supported in default-server: Yes
10469
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010470resolve-prefer <family>
10471 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10472 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10473 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10474 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10475
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010476 Default value: ipv6
10477
10478 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010479
10480 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10481
10482resolvers <id>
10483 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10484 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010485 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
10486 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
10487 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
10488 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010489
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010490 Supported in default-server: No
10491
10492 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010493
10494 See also chapter 5.3
10495
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010496send-proxy
10497 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10498 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10499 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10500 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
10501 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
10502 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
10503 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
10504 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
10505 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010506 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
10507 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
10508 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
10509 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
10510 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010511
10512 Supported in default-server: No
10513
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010514send-proxy-v2
10515 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10516 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10517 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10518 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10519 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10520 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10521 option of the "bind" keyword.
10522
10523 Supported in default-server: No
10524
10525send-proxy-v2-ssl
10526 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10527 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10528 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10529 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10530 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10531 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10532 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10533 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10534
10535 Supported in default-server: No
10536
10537send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10538 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10539 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10540 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10541 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10542 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10543 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10544 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10545 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10546 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10547
10548 Supported in default-server: No
10549
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010550slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010551 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10552 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10553 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10554 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10555 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10556 parameters :
10557
10558 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10559 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10560
10561 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10562 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10563 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10564 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10565
10566 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10567 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10568 seen as failed.
10569
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010570 Supported in default-server: Yes
10571
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020010572sni <expression>
10573 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
10574 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
10575 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
10576 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
10577 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
10578
10579 Supported in default-server: no
10580
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010581source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010582source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010583source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010584 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10585 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10586 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10587 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10588
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010589 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10590 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10591 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10592 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10593 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10594 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10595 server.
10596
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010597 Supported in default-server: No
10598
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010599ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010600 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10601 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10602 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10603 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10604 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10605 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010606 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010607
10608 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010609
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020010610tcp-ut <delay>
10611 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
10612 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
10613 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
10614 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
10615 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
10616 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
10617 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
10618 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
10619 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
10620 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
10621 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
10622 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
10623 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010625track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010626 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10627 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10628 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10629 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010630 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010632 Supported in default-server: No
10633
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010634verify [none|required]
10635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010636 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10637 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10638 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10639 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010640 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10641 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10642 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010643
10644 Supported in default-server: No
10645
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010646verifyhost <hostname>
10647 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10648 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10649 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10650 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10651 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10652 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10653
10654 Supported in default-server: No
10655
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010656weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010657 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10658 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10659 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010660 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10661 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10662 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10663 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10664 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10665 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010666
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010667 Supported in default-server: Yes
10668
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010669
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200106705.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
10671-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010672
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010673HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
10674using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10675configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010676This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
10677can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
10678workload.
10679This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
10680resolution at run time.
10681Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
10682carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
10683
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010684Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
10685health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
10686
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010687
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200106885.3.1. Global overview
10689----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010690
10691As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
10692different steps of the process life:
10693
10694 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
10695 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
10696 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
10697
10698 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
10699 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
10700 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
10701
10702A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
10703 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
10704 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
10705 resolution to know this new IP.
10706
10707A few things important to notice:
10708 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
10709 first valid response.
10710
10711 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
10712 servers return an error.
10713
10714
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200107155.3.2. The resolvers section
10716----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010717
10718This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
10719HAProxy.
10720There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
10721many name servers.
10722
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010723When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
10724uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
10725is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
10726answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
10727
10728When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
10729used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
10730
10731Two types of behavior can be applied:
10732 1. stop DNS resolution
10733 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
10734 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
10735 1. ANY query type
10736 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
10737 server's parameter
10738 3. remaining family type
10739
10740HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
10741 - invalid DNS response packet
10742 - wrong name in the query section of the response
10743 - NX domain
10744 - Query refused by server
10745 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
10746
10747HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
10748 - no Answer records in the response
10749 - DNS response truncated
10750 - Error in DNS response
10751 - No expected DNS records found in the response
10752 - name server timeout
10753
10754For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
10755 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
10756 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
10757 applied;
10758 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
10759 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
10760 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
10761 stops resolution.
10762
10763
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010764resolvers <resolvers id>
10765 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
10766
10767A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
10768
10769nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
10770 DNS server description:
10771 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
10772 <ip> : IP address of the server
10773 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
10774
10775hold <status> <period>
10776 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
10777 on last resolution <status>
10778 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
10779 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
10780 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10781 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
10782
10783 Default value is 10s for "valid".
10784
10785 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
10786 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
10787 the healch check.
10788
10789resolve_retries <nb>
10790 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
10791 giving up.
10792 Default value: 3
10793
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010794 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
10795 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
10796 type.
10797
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010798timeout <event> <time>
10799 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
10800 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
10801 events available are:
10802 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
10803 been received.
10804 Default value: 1s
10805 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10806 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
10807
10808Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
10809
10810 resolvers mydns
10811 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
10812 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
10813 resolve_retries 3
10814 timeout retry 1s
10815 hold valid 10s
10816
10817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108186. HTTP header manipulation
10819---------------------------
10820
10821In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
10822response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
10823request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
10824which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010825against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010826
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010827If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
10828to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
10829but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
10830HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
10831stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
10832because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
10833a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
10834still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020010835
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010836This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
10837in section 4.2 :
10838
10839 - reqadd <string>
10840 - reqallow <search>
10841 - reqiallow <search>
10842 - reqdel <search>
10843 - reqidel <search>
10844 - reqdeny <search>
10845 - reqideny <search>
10846 - reqpass <search>
10847 - reqipass <search>
10848 - reqrep <search> <replace>
10849 - reqirep <search> <replace>
10850 - reqtarpit <search>
10851 - reqitarpit <search>
10852 - rspadd <string>
10853 - rspdel <search>
10854 - rspidel <search>
10855 - rspdeny <search>
10856 - rspideny <search>
10857 - rsprep <search> <replace>
10858 - rspirep <search> <replace>
10859
10860With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
10861is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
10862parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
10863prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
10864Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
10865
10866 \t for a tab
10867 \r for a carriage return (CR)
10868 \n for a new line (LF)
10869 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
10870 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
10871 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
10872 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
10873 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
10874
10875The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
10876portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
10877above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
10878regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
108799 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
10880is very common to users of the "sed" program.
10881
10882The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
10883after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
10884
10885Notes related to these keywords :
10886---------------------------------
10887 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
10888 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
10889 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
10890
10891 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
10892 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
10893 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
10894
10895 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
10896 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
10897 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
10898 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
10899 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
10900
10901 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
10902 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
10903 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
10904 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
10905 useless headers before adding new ones.
10906
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010907 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010908 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
10909
10910 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
10911 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
10912 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
10913
10914 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
10915 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010916 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010917
10918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200109197. Using ACLs and fetching samples
10920----------------------------------
10921
10922Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
10923client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
10924The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
10925these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
10926but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
10927data called patterns.
10928
10929
109307.1. ACL basics
10931---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010932
10933The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
10934content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
10935from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
10936simple :
10937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010938 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010939 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010940 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
10941 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010943The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
10944adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010945
10946In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
10947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010948 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010949
10950This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
10951Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
10952and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010953an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
10954conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
10955as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
10956are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010957
10958ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
10959'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
10960which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
10961
10962There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
10963performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
10964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010965The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
10966specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
10967this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010968methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
10969ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010970
10971Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
10972 - boolean
10973 - integer (signed or unsigned)
10974 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
10975 - string
10976 - data block
10977
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010978Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
10979converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
10980would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
10981The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
10982which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
10983
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010984Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
10985keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10986fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10987which are summarized in the table below :
10988
10989 +---------------------+-----------------+
10990 | Sample or converter | Default |
10991 | output type | matching method |
10992 +---------------------+-----------------+
10993 | boolean | bool |
10994 +---------------------+-----------------+
10995 | integer | int |
10996 +---------------------+-----------------+
10997 | ip | ip |
10998 +---------------------+-----------------+
10999 | string | str |
11000 +---------------------+-----------------+
11001 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11002 +---------------------+-----------------+
11003
11004Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11005matching method, see below.
11006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011007The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11008 - boolean
11009 - integer or integer range
11010 - IP address / network
11011 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11012 - regular expression
11013 - hex block
11014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011015The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11016
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011017 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11018 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011019 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011020 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011021 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011022 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011023 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011025The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11026read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11027if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11028lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11029will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11030beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11031a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11032lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11033exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11034
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011035The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11036parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11037ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11038a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11039check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11040
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011041The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11042socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11043file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011045Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11046loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11047
11048 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11049
11050In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11051the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11052case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11053as well.
11054
11055The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11056sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11057do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11058methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11059is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11060obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11061followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11062default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11063that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11064string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11065
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011066The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11067By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11068string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11069resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11070server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11071waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11072flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11073function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011075There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11076sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11077be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011078
11079 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11080 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011081 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11082 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11083 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11084 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011085
11086 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11087 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011088 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011089
11090 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011091 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011092
11093 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011094 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011095
11096 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11097 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11098
11099 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11100 binary or string samples.
11101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011102 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11103 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011105 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11106 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11107 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011109 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11110 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011112 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11113 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011115 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11116 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011118 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11119 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011120 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011122 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11123 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11124 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011125
11126For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11127request, it is possible to do :
11128
11129 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11130
11131In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11132buffer, one would use the following acl :
11133
11134 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11135
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011136On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11137possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11138
11139 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011141All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11142criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11143method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11144to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11145criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11146the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011148If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011149the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11150For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011152 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11153 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11154 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11155 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011156
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011157
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011158The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11159types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11160combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11161brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11162default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011164 +-------------------------------------------------+
11165 | Input sample type |
11166 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011167 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011168 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11169 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11170 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011171 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011172 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011173 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011174 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011175 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011176 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011177 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011178 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011179 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011180 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011181 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011182 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011183 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011184 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011185 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011186 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011187 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011188 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011189 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011190 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011191 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011192 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11193 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11194 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011195
11196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200111977.1.1. Matching booleans
11198------------------------
11199
11200In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11201Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11202When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11203that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11204
11205Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11206return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11207"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11208
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200112107.1.2. Matching integers
11211------------------------
11212
11213Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11214enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11215to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11216
11217Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11218matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11219lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011220
11221For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11222unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11223representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11224
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011225As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11226two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11227instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11228ranges and operators.
11229
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011230For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011231operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11232Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11233of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011234
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011235Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011236
11237 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11238 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11239 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11240 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11241 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11242
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011243For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011244
11245 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11246
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011247This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11248
11249 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11250
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200112527.1.3. Matching strings
11253-----------------------
11254
11255String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11256different forms :
11257
11258 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11259 patterns ;
11260
11261 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11262 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11263
11264 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11265 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11266
11267 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11268 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11269
11270 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11271 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11272 matches.
11273
11274 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11275 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11276 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011277
11278String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11279exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11280characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11281string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11282to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011283before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011284
11285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200112867.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11287---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011288
11289Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11290they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11291possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11292passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11293the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011294the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11295match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011296
11297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200112987.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11299-------------------------------------
11300
11301It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11302not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11303a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11304to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11305digits may be used upper or lower case.
11306
11307Example :
11308 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11309 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11310
11311
113127.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11313---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011314
11315IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11316netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11317within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011318host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011319difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11320at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11321does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11322parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011323
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011324IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11325Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11326trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11327IPv6 patterns.
11328
11329HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11330following situations :
11331 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11332 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11333 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11334 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11335 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11336 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11337 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11338 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11339 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11340 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011342
113437.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11344----------------------------------
11345
11346Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11347combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11348
11349 - AND (implicit)
11350 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11351 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011353A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011355 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011357Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11358indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011360For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11361"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11362requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11363is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11364
11365 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11366 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11367 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11368 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11369
11370To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11371and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11372
11373 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11374 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11375 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11376 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11377
11378 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11379 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11380 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11381 use_backend www if host_www
11382
11383It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11384expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11385be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11386the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11387
11388 The following rule :
11389
11390 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11391 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11392
11393 Can also be written that way :
11394
11395 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11396
11397It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11398to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11399simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11400sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11401good use is the following :
11402
11403 With named ACLs :
11404
11405 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11406 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11407 monitor fail if site_dead
11408
11409 With anonymous ACLs :
11410
11411 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11412
11413See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11414
11415
114167.3. Fetching samples
11417---------------------
11418
11419Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11420against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11421sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11422ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11423of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11424available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11425
11426This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11427Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11428compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11429deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11430
11431The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11432matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11433method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11434indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11435
11436As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11437when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11438mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11439the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11440ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11441
11442Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11443multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11444when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11445incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11446are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11447is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11448all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11449
11450Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11451 - name
11452 - name(arg1)
11453 - name(arg1,arg2)
11454
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011455
114567.3.1. Converters
11457-----------------
11458
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011459Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11460of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11461is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11462was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11463has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11464unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11465
11466These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11467sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11468the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11469support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011470
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011471A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11472support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11473supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11474(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11475bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011477The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011478
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011479add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011480 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011481 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
11482 name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope. The
11483 allowed scopes are:
11484 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11485 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11486 response),
11487 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11488 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11489 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11490 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011491
11492and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011493 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011494 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
11495 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an
11496 indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11497 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11498 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11499 response),
11500 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11501 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11502 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11503 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011504
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011505base64
11506 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11507 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11508 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11509
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011510bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011511 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011512 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11513 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11514 presence of a flag).
11515
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011516bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11517 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11518 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11519 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11520
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011521cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011522 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11523 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011524
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011525crc32([<avalanche>])
11526 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11527 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11528 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11529 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11530 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11531 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11532 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11533 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11534 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11535 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11536 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11537
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010011538da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011539 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11540 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11541 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11542 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
11543 ('|'). There's a limit of 5 different properties imposed by the haproxy
11544 configuration language.
11545
11546 Example:
11547 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011548 bind *:8881
11549 default_backend servers
11550 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011551
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011552debug
11553 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11554 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11555 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11556
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011557div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011558 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11559 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011560 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
11561 variable name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about it
11562 scope. The scope allowed are:
11563 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11564 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11565 response),
11566 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11567 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11568 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11569 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011570
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011571djb2([<avalanche>])
11572 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11573 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11574 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11575 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11576 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11577 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11578 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011579 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11580 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011581
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011582even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011583 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011584 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11585
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011586field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11587 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11588 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11589 list of chars.
11590
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011591hex
11592 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11593 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11594 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11595 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011596
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011597http_date([<offset>])
11598 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11599 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11600 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11601 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11602 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11603 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011604
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011605in_table(<table>)
11606 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11607 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11608 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11609 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11610 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11611
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011612ipmask(<mask>)
11613 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11614 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11615 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11616 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11617
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011618json([<input-code>])
11619 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11620 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11621 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11622 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11623 of errors:
11624 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11625 bytes, ...)
11626 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11627 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11628
11629 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11630 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11631 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11632 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11633 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11634 are :
11635 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11636 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11637 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11638 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11639 error ;
11640 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11641 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11642
11643 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11644 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11645
11646 Example:
11647 capture request header user-agent len 150
11648 capture request header Host len 15
11649 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
11650
11651 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11652 GET / HTTP/1.0
11653 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11654
11655 Output log:
11656 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11657
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011658language(<value>[,<default>])
11659 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11660 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11661 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11662 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11663 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
11664 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
11665 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
11666 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
11667 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
11668 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
11669 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
11670 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011671
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011672 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011673
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011674 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
11675 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011676
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011677 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
11678 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
11679 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
11680 use_backend spanish if es
11681 use_backend french if fr
11682 use_backend english if en
11683 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011684
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011685lower
11686 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
11687 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11688 type. The result is of type string.
11689
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011690ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
11691 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11692 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
11693 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11694 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11695 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11696 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
11697
11698 Example :
11699
11700 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
11701 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11702 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11703
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011704map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11705map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11706map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11707 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
11708 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
11709 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
11710 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
11711 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
11712 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
11713 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
11714 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011715
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011716 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
11717 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
11718 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011719
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011720 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
11721 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011722
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011723 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
11724 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11725 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
11726 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020011727 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
11728 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011729 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
11730 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11731 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
11732 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11733 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
11734 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11735 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
11736 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11737 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
11738 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11739 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
11740 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11741 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
11742 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011743
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011744 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
11745 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
11746 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
11747 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
11748 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011749
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011750 Example :
11751
11752 # this is a comment and is ignored
11753 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
11754 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
11755 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
11756 | | | `---------- value
11757 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
11758 | `---------------------------- key
11759 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
11760
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011761mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011762 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11763 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011764 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11765 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11766 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11767 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11768 response),
11769 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11770 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11771 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11772 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011773
11774mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011775 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020011776 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
11777 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011778 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11779 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11780 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11781 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11782 response),
11783 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11784 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11785 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11786 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011787
11788neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011789 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
11790 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
11791 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
11792 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011793
11794not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011795 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011796 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11797 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11798 absence of a flag).
11799
11800odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011801 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011802 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
11803
11804or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011805 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011806 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
11807 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an
11808 indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11809 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11810 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11811 response),
11812 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11813 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11814 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11815 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011816
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010011817regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010011818 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
11819 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
11820 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
11821 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
11822 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
11823 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
11824 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
11825 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
11826 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
11827 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
11828 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
11829 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
11830 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
11831
11832 Example :
11833
11834 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
11835 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
11836 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
11837 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
11838
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011839capture-req(<id>)
11840 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
11841 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11842
11843 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11844 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11845 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11846
11847capture-res(<id>)
11848 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
11849 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11850
11851 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11852 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11853 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11854
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011855sdbm([<avalanche>])
11856 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
11857 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11858 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11859 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11860 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11861 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11862 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011863 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
11864 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011865
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011866set-var(<var name>)
11867 Sets a variable with the input content and return the content on the output as
11868 is. The variable keep the value and the associated input type. The name of the
11869 variable starts by an indication about it scope. The scope allowed are:
11870 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11871 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11872 response),
11873 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11874 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11875 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11876 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
11877
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011878sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011879 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
11880 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011881 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
11882 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
11883 scope. The allowed scopes are:
11884 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11885 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11886 response),
11887 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11888 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11889 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11890 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011891
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011892table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
11893 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11894 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11895 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
11896 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11897 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11898 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
11899
11900
11901table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
11902 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11903 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11904 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
11905 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11906 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11907 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
11908
11909table_conn_cnt(<table>)
11910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11912 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11913 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
11914 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11915
11916table_conn_cur(<table>)
11917 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11918 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11919 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11920 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11921 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
11922
11923table_conn_rate(<table>)
11924 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11925 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11926 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
11927 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11928 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
11929
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011930table_gpt0(<table>)
11931 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11932 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
11933 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11934 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11935 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
11936
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011937table_gpc0(<table>)
11938 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11939 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11940 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11941 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
11942 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
11943
11944table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
11945 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11946 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11947 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
11948 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
11949 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
11950 sample fetch keyword.
11951
11952table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
11953 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11954 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11955 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11956 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11957 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11958
11959table_http_err_rate(<table>)
11960 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11961 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11962 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
11963 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
11964 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
11965 keyword.
11966
11967table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
11968 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11969 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11970 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11971 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
11972 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11973
11974table_http_req_rate(<table>)
11975 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11976 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11977 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
11978 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
11979 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
11980 keyword.
11981
11982table_kbytes_in(<table>)
11983 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11984 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11985 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
11986 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11987 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11988 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
11989 keyword.
11990
11991table_kbytes_out(<table>)
11992 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11993 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11994 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
11995 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11996 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11997 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
11998 keyword.
11999
12000table_server_id(<table>)
12001 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12002 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12003 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12004 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12005 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12006 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12007
12008table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12009 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12010 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12011 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12012 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12013 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12014 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12015 keyword.
12016
12017table_sess_rate(<table>)
12018 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12019 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12020 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12021 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12022 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12023 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12024 keyword.
12025
12026table_trackers(<table>)
12027 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12028 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12029 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12030 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12031 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12032 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12033 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12034 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12035 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12036 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12037
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012038upper
12039 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12040 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12041 type. The result is of type string.
12042
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012043url_dec
12044 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12045 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12046
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012047utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12048 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12049 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12050 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12051 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12052 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12053 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12054
12055 Example :
12056
12057 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12058 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12059 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12060
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012061word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12062 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12063 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12064
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012065wt6([<avalanche>])
12066 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12067 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12068 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12069 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12070 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12071 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12072 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012073 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12074 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012075
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012076xor(<value>)
12077 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012078 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012079 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
12080 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
12081 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
12082 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
12083 response),
12084 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
12085 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
12086 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12087 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012088
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012089
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200120907.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012091--------------------------------------------
12092
12093A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12094not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12095"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12096The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12097
12098always_false : boolean
12099 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12100 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12101
12102always_true : boolean
12103 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12104 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12105
12106avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012107 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012108 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12109 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12110 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12111 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12112 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12113 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12114 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12115 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12116 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12117 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12118 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12119 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12120 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012122be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012123 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12124 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12125 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12126 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12127 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012129be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12130 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12131 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12132 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12133 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12134 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12135 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012136
12137 Example :
12138 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12139 backend dynamic
12140 mode http
12141 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12142 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012143
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012144bin(<hexa>) : bin
12145 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12146 of the string.
12147
12148bool(<bool>) : bool
12149 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12150 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012152connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12153 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012154 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012155 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12156 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012157
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012158 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012159 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012160 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12161
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012162 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12163 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012164
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012165 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012166 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012167 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012168 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12169 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012170 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012171 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012172
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012173 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12174 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012175 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012176 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012177
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012178date([<offset>]) : integer
12179 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12180 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12181 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12182 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012183 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12184
12185 Example :
12186
12187 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12188 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012189
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012190env(<name>) : string
12191 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12192 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12193 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12194 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12195 certain way.
12196
12197 Examples :
12198 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12199 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12200
12201 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12202 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012204fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12205 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012206 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12207 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012208 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12209 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12210 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12211 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12212 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012214fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12215 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12216 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12217 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12218 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12219 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12220 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12221 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12222 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012223
12224 Example :
12225 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12226 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12227 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12228 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12229 frontend mail
12230 bind :25
12231 mode tcp
12232 maxconn 100
12233 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12234 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12235 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12236 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012237
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012238int(<integer>) : signed integer
12239 Returns a signed integer.
12240
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012241ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12242 Returns an ipv4.
12243
12244ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12245 Returns an ipv6.
12246
12247meth(<method>) : method
12248 Returns a method.
12249
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012250nbproc : integer
12251 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12252 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12253 and debugging purposes.
12254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012255nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12256 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12257 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12258 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012259 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12260 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12261 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012262
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012263proc : integer
12264 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12265 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12266 debugging purposes.
12267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012268queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012269 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12270 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12271 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012272 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12273 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12274 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12275 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12276 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12277
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012278rand([<range>]) : integer
12279 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12280 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12281 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12282 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12283 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012285srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12286 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12287 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12288 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12289 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12290 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12291 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12292 methods.
12293
12294srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12295 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12296 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12297 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12298 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12299 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12300 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12301 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12302
12303srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12304 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12305 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012306 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012307 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12308 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12309 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12310 overloading servers).
12311
12312 Example :
12313 # Redirect to a separate back
12314 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12315 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12316 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12317
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012318stopping : boolean
12319 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12320 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12321 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12322
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012323str(<string>) : string
12324 Returns a string.
12325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012326table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12327 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12328 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12329
12330table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12331 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12332 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12333 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12334
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012335var(<var-name>) : undefined
12336 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
12337 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
12338 scope. The scope allowed are:
12339 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
12340 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
12341 response),
12342 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
12343 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
12344 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12345 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012347
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200123487.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012349----------------------------------
12350
12351The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12352closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12353methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12354sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12355TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012356the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12357counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12358"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012359argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12360the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12361this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012362
12363be_id : integer
12364 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12365 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12366
12367dst : ip
12368 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12369 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12370 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12371 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12372 RFC 4291.
12373
12374dst_conn : integer
12375 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12376 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12377 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12378 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12379 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12380 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12381 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12382 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012384dst_port : integer
12385 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12386 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12387 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12388 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12389 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12390 an HTTP header.
12391
12392fe_id : integer
12393 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12394 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12395 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12396
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012397sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012398sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12399sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12400sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012401 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12402 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12403 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12404
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012405sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012406sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12407sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12408sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012409 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12410 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12411 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12412
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012413sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012414sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12415sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12416sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012417 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12418 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012419 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12420 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12421 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012422
12423 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12424 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012425 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12426 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12427 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012428 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12429 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12430
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012431sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012432sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12433sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12434sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012435 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12436 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12437
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012438sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012439sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12440sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12441sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012442 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12443 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
12444 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
12445
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012446sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012447sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12448sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12449sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012450 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
12451 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
12452 See also src_conn_rate.
12453
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012454sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012455sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12456sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12457sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012458 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012459 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012460
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012461sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
12462sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12463sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12464sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12465 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12466 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
12467
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012468sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012469sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12470sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12471sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012472 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12473 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
12474 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012475 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12476 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12477 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012478
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012479sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012480sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12481sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12482sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012483 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
12484 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
12485 See also src_http_err_cnt.
12486
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012487sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012488sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12489sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12490sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012491 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
12492 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12493 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
12494 src_http_err_rate.
12495
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012496sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012497sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12498sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12499sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012500 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12501 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12502 src_http_req_cnt.
12503
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012504sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012505sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12506sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12507sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012508 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12509 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
12510 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12511 src_http_req_rate.
12512
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012513sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012514sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12515sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12516sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012517 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012518 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
12519 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
12520 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
12521 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012522
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012523 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12524 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012525 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12526
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012527sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012528sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12529sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12530sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012531 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
12532 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12533 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012534
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012535sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012536sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12537sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12538sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012539 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
12540 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12541 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012542
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012543sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012544sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12545sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12546sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012547 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
12548 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
12549 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
12550 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012551 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012552 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
12553
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012554sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012555sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12556sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12557sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012558 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12559 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12560 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12561 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12562 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012563 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012564
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012565sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012566sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12567sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12568sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012569 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12570 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12571 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12572
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012573sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012574sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12575sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12576sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012577 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12578 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012579 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012580 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
12581 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012582 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
12583 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
12584 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012586so_id : integer
12587 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
12588 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
12589 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012591src : ip
12592 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12593 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12594 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12595 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
12596 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
12597 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
12598 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012599
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012600 Example:
12601 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12602 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012604src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12605 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12606 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12607 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012608 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012610src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12611 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12612 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012613 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012614 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012616src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12617 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12618 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12619 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12620 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12621 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12622 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012623
12624 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12625 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12626 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12627 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012628 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012629 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12630 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012632src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012633 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012634 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012635 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012636 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012638src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012639 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012640 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12641 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012642 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012644src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12645 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12646 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12647 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012648 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012650src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012651 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012652 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012653 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012654 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012655
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012656src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12657 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12658 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
12659 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
12660 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
12661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012662src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012663 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012664 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012665 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
12666 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012667 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12668 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12669 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012671src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12672 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
12673 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012674 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012675 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012676 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012678src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12679 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
12680 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12681 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12682 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012683 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012685src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12686 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12687 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12688 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012689 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012691src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12692 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12693 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12694 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012695 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012696 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012698src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12699 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12700 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12701 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012702 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012703 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
12704 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012705
12706 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012707 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012708 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012710src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012711 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
12712 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
12713 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
12714 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
12715 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012717src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012718 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
12719 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12720 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
12721 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
12722 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012724src_port : integer
12725 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
12726 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
12727 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
12728 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012730src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12731 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012732 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12733 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
12734 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012735 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012737src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12738 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
12739 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12740 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12741 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012742 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012744src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12745 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
12746 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
12747 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
12748 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
12749 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
12750 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
12751 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
12752 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012753
12754 Example :
12755 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
12756 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
12757 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
12758 listen ssh
12759 bind :22
12760 mode tcp
12761 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012762 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012763 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012764 server local 127.0.0.1:22
12765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012766srv_id : integer
12767 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
12768 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
12769 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020012770
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010012771
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200127727.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012773----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020012774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012775The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
12776closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
12777when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
12778usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012779future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012780
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012781ssl_bc : boolean
12782 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12783 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
12784 other a server with the "ssl" option.
12785
12786ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
12787 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
12788 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12789
12790ssl_bc_cipher : string
12791 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
12792 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12793
12794ssl_bc_protocol : string
12795 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
12796 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12797
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012798ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012799 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012800 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12801 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012802
12803ssl_bc_session_id : binary
12804 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
12805 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
12806 if session was reused or not.
12807
12808ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
12809 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
12810 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012812ssl_c_ca_err : integer
12813 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12814 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
12815 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
12816 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
12817 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012819ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
12820 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12821 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
12822 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
12823 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012824
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012825ssl_c_der : binary
12826 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
12827 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12828 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012830ssl_c_err : integer
12831 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12832 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
12833 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
12834 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
12835 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012837ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12838 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12839 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12840 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12841 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12842 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12843 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12844 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12845 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012847ssl_c_key_alg : string
12848 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12849 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12850 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012852ssl_c_notafter : string
12853 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
12854 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12855 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012857ssl_c_notbefore : string
12858 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
12859 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12860 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012862ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12863 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12864 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12865 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12866 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12867 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12868 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12869 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12870 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012872ssl_c_serial : binary
12873 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
12874 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12875 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012877ssl_c_sha1 : binary
12878 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
12879 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
12880 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020012881 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
12882 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
12883
12884 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012886ssl_c_sig_alg : string
12887 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12888 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12889 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012891ssl_c_used : boolean
12892 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
12893 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012895ssl_c_verify : integer
12896 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
12897 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
12898 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
12899 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012901ssl_c_version : integer
12902 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
12903 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012904
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012905ssl_f_der : binary
12906 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
12907 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12908 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012910ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12911 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12912 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12913 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12914 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012915 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012916 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12917 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12918 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012920ssl_f_key_alg : string
12921 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12922 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
12923 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012925ssl_f_notafter : string
12926 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12927 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12928 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012930ssl_f_notbefore : string
12931 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12932 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12933 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012935ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12936 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12937 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12938 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12939 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12940 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12941 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12942 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12943 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012945ssl_f_serial : binary
12946 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12947 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12948 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012949
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020012950ssl_f_sha1 : binary
12951 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
12952 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
12953 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
12954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012955ssl_f_sig_alg : string
12956 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12957 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12958 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012960ssl_f_version : integer
12961 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12962 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12963
12964ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012965 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12966 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
12967 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
12968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012969 Example :
12970 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
12971 listen http-https
12972 bind :80
12973 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
12974 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
12975
12976ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
12977 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
12978 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12979
12980ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012981 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012982 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
12983 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
12984 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
12985 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
12986 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
12987 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
12988 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
12989 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
12990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012991ssl_fc_cipher : string
12992 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
12993 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012995ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012996 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
12997 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010012998 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
12999 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13000 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13001 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013003ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13004 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013005 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13006 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13007 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13008 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013009
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013010ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
13011 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13012 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013014ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013015 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013016 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13017 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13018 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13019 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13020 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13021 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13022 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013024ssl_fc_protocol : string
13025 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13026 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013027
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013028ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013029 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013030 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13031 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013033ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13034 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13035 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13036 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13037 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013039ssl_fc_sni : string
13040 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13041 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13042 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13043 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13044 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13045
13046 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13047 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13048 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013049 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13050 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013052 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013053 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13054 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013056ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13057 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13058 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013059
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013060
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200130617.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013062------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013064Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13065sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13066only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13067For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13068be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13069can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13070sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13071for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13072content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013074payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13075 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13076 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13077 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013079payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13080 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13081 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13082 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013084req.len : integer
13085req_len : integer (deprecated)
13086 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13087 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13088 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13089 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13090 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13091 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13092 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13093 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013095req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13096 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013097 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13098 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13099 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13100 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013102 ACL alternatives :
13103 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013105req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13106 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13107 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13108 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13109 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013111 ACL alternatives :
13112 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013114 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013116req.proto_http : boolean
13117req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13118 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13119 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13120 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13121 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13122 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13123 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13124 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013126 Example:
13127 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13128 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13129 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013130 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013132req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13133rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13134 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13135 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13136 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13137 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13138 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13139 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13140 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013142 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13143 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13144 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13145 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13146 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13147 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013149 ACL derivatives :
13150 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013152 Example :
13153 listen tse-farm
13154 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13155 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13156 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13157 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13158 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13159 persist rdp-cookie
13160 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13161 # This is only useful makes sense if
13162 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13163 stick-table type string size 204800
13164 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13165 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13166 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013168 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13169 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013171req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13172rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13173 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13174 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13175 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13176 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013178 ACL derivatives :
13179 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013180
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013181req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13182 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13183 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013184 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13185 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13186 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13187 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13188 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013190req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13191req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13192 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13193 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13194 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13195 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13196 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13197 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13198 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013200req.ssl_sni : string
13201req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13202 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13203 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13204 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13205 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13206 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13207 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13208 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13209 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13210 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13211 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13212 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13213 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013215 ACL derivatives :
13216 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013218 Examples :
13219 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13220 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13221 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13222 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13223 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013224
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013225req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13226 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13227 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13228 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13229 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13230 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13231 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13232 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13233 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13234 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013236req.ssl_ver : integer
13237req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13238 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13239 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13240 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13241 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13242 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13243 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13244 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13245 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13246 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013248 ACL derivatives :
13249 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013250
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013251res.len : integer
13252 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13253 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13254 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13255 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13256 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13257 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13258 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13259 content inspection.
13260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013261res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13262 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013263 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13264 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13265 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13266 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013268res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13269 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13270 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13271 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13272 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013274 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013275
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013276res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13277rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13278 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13279 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13280 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13281 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13282 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13283 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13284 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013286wait_end : boolean
13287 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13288 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13289 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13290 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13291 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13292 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13293 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13294 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013296 Examples :
13297 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13298 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13299 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013301 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13302 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13303 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13304 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13305 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13306 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13307 tcp-request content reject
13308
13309
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200133107.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013311--------------------------------------
13312
13313It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13314This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13315data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13316its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13317HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13318content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13319to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13320more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13321response are indexed.
13322
13323base : string
13324 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13325 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13326 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13327 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13328 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13329 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13330 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13331 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
13332
13333 ACL derivatives :
13334 base : exact string match
13335 base_beg : prefix match
13336 base_dir : subdir match
13337 base_dom : domain match
13338 base_end : suffix match
13339 base_len : length match
13340 base_reg : regex match
13341 base_sub : substring match
13342
13343base32 : integer
13344 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
13345 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
13346 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013347 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
13348 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
13349 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013350
13351base32+src : binary
13352 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
13353 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
13354 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
13355 per-URL counters.
13356
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013357capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
13358 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
13359 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13360 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
13361
13362capture.req.method : string
13363 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
13364 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
13365 because it's allocated.
13366
13367capture.req.uri : string
13368 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
13369 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
13370 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
13371 allocated.
13372
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013373capture.req.ver : string
13374 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13375 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
13376 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
13377
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013378capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
13379 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
13380 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13381 The first entry is an index of 0.
13382 See also: "capture response header"
13383
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013384capture.res.ver : string
13385 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13386 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
13387 persistent flag.
13388
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013389req.body : binary
13390 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
13391 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13392 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13393 the first chunk is analyzed.
13394
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013395req.body_param([<name>) : string
13396 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13397 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13398 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13399 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13400 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13401 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13402 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13403 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13404 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13405 given.
13406
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013407req.body_len : integer
13408 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13409 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13410 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13411 "option http-buffer-request".
13412
13413req.body_size : integer
13414 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13415 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13416 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13417 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13418 "option http-buffer-request".
13419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013420req.cook([<name>]) : string
13421cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13422 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13423 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13424 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13425 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13426 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13427 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13428 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13429 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13430
13431 ACL derivatives :
13432 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13433 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
13434 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
13435 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
13436 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
13437 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
13438 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
13439 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013441req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13442cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13443 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13444 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013446req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13447cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13448 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13449 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
13450 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
13451 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013453cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13454 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13455 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
13456 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
13457 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013458 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013459 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
13460 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
13461 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
13462 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013464hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13465 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
13466 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
13467 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
13468 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013469 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013471req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
13472 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13473 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13474 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13475 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13476 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13477 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
13478 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
13479 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013481req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13482 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13483 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13484 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13485 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013487req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13488 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13489 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13490 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13491 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13492 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13493 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
13494 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
13495 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
13496 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
13497 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
13498 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013500 ACL derivatives :
13501 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13502 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13503 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13504 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13505 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13506 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13507 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13508 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13509
13510req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13511hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
13512 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13513 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
13514 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
13515 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
13516 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
13517 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
13518 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
13519 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
13520 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
13521
13522req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13523hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13524 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
13525 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
13526 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
13527 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13528 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13529 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13530 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
13531 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
13532
13533req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13534hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13535 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
13536 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
13537 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
13538 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13539 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13540 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13541 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
13542
13543http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
13544 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
13545 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
13546 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13547 basic auth is supported.
13548
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013549http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
13550 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
13551 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
13552 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
13553 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013554 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13555 basic auth is supported.
13556
13557 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013558 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
13559 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
13560 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
13561 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013562
13563http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013564 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
13565 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013566 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
13567 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013569method : integer + string
13570 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
13571 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
13572 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
13573 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
13574 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
13575 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
13576 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013578 ACL derivatives :
13579 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013581 Example :
13582 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
13583 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
13584 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013586path : string
13587 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
13588 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
13589 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
13590 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
13591 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
13592 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
13593 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013595 ACL derivatives :
13596 path : exact string match
13597 path_beg : prefix match
13598 path_dir : subdir match
13599 path_dom : domain match
13600 path_end : suffix match
13601 path_len : length match
13602 path_reg : regex match
13603 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013604
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010013605query : string
13606 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
13607 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
13608 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
13609 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
13610 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
13611 which stops before the question mark.
13612
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013613req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13614 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13615 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13616 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13617 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013619req.ver : string
13620req_ver : string (deprecated)
13621 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13622 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13623 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013625 ACL derivatives :
13626 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013628res.comp : boolean
13629 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13630 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13631 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013633res.comp_algo : string
13634 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13635 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13636 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013638res.cook([<name>]) : string
13639scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13640 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13641 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13642 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013644 ACL derivatives :
13645 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013647res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13648scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13649 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13650 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
13651 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013653res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13654scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13655 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13656 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
13657 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013659res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13660 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13661 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13662 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13663 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13664 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
13665 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
13666 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
13667 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
13668 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013670res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13671 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13672 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13673 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13674 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
13675 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013677res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13678shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
13679 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13680 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13681 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13682 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13683 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
13684 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
13685 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
13686 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013688 ACL derivatives :
13689 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13690 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13691 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13692 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13693 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13694 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13695 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13696 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13697
13698res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13699shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13700 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13701 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13702 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
13703 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
13704 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013706res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13707shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13708 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
13709 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
13710 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
13711 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
13712 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
13713 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013714
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013715res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13716 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13717 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13718 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13719 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013721res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13722shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13723 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
13724 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13725 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13726 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13727 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
13728 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013730res.ver : string
13731resp_ver : string (deprecated)
13732 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
13733 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013735 ACL derivatives :
13736 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013738set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13739 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13740 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013741 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013742 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013744 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
13745 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013747status : integer
13748 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
13749 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
13750 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013752url : string
13753 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
13754 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
13755 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
13756 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
13757 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
13758 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
13759 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013761 ACL derivatives :
13762 url : exact string match
13763 url_beg : prefix match
13764 url_dir : subdir match
13765 url_dom : domain match
13766 url_end : suffix match
13767 url_len : length match
13768 url_reg : regex match
13769 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013771url_ip : ip
13772 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
13773 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
13774 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
13775 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
13776 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
13777 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13778 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013780url_port : integer
13781 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
13782 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
13783 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13784 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013785
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013786urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
13787url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013788 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
13789 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013790 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
13791 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
13792 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
13793 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013794 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
13795 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013796 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
13797 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013799 ACL derivatives :
13800 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
13801 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
13802 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
13803 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
13804 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
13805 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
13806 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
13807 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013808
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013810 Example :
13811 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
13812 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
13813 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
13814 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013815
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013816urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013817 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
13818 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
13819 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020013820
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010013821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200138227.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013823---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013825Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
13826every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013827order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013828
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013829ACL name Equivalent to Usage
13830---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013831FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020013832HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013833HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
13834HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013835HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
13836HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
13837HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
13838HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
13839LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013840METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
13841METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
13842METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
13843METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
13844METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
13845METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013846RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013847REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013848TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013849WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
13850---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013851
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010013852
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138538. Logging
13854----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013855
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013856One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
13857provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
13858very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
13859provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
13860state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013861to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013862headers.
13863
13864In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
13865about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
13866send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
13867
13868 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
13869 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
13870 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
13871 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
13872 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060013873 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
13874 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013875
13876The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
13877allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
13878as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
13879while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
13880real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
13881delay.
13882
13883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138848.1. Log levels
13885---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013886
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013887TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013888source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013889HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
13890in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
13891track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
13892syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
13893about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013894
13895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138968.2. Log formats
13897----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013898
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013899HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013900and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
13901slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
13902options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013903
13904 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
13905 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
13906 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
13907 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
13908 extents.
13909
13910 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
13911 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
13912 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
13913 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
13914 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
13915
13916 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
13917 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
13918 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
13919 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
13920 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
13921
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020013922 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
13923 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
13924 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
13925 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
13926
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013927 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
13928
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013929Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
13930specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
13931field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
13932servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
13933always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
13934identifier.
13935
13936Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
13937 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
13938 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
13939 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
13940 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
13941
13942
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139438.2.1. Default log format
13944-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013945
13946This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
13947as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
13948format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
13949
13950 Example :
13951 listen www
13952 mode http
13953 log global
13954 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13955
13956 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
13957 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
13958 (www/HTTP)
13959
13960 Field Format Extract from the example above
13961 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
13962 2 'Connect from' Connect from
13963 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
13964 4 'to' to
13965 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
13966 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
13967
13968Detailed fields description :
13969 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
13970 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
13971 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
13972 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
13973 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13974 and processed the connection.
13975 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
13976
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013977In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
13978"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
13979connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
13980
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013981It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
13982will eventually disappear.
13983
13984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139858.2.2. TCP log format
13986---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013987
13988The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
13989is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
13990information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
13991counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
13992emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
13993environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
13994the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
13995sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013996specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
13997not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
13998fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
13999marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014000
14001 Example :
14002 frontend fnt
14003 mode tcp
14004 option tcplog
14005 log global
14006 default_backend bck
14007
14008 backend bck
14009 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14010
14011 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14012 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14013 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14014
14015 Field Format Extract from the example above
14016 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14017 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14018 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14019 4 frontend_name fnt
14020 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14021 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14022 7 bytes_read* 212
14023 8 termination_state --
14024 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14025 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14026
14027Detailed fields description :
14028 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014029 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14030 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14031 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
14032 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
14033 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014034
14035 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014036 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14037 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14038 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014039
14040 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14041 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14042 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14043 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14044
14045 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14046 and processed the connection.
14047
14048 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14049 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14050 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14051 applications.
14052
14053 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14054 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14055 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14056 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14057 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14058
14059 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14060 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14061 See "Timers" below for more details.
14062
14063 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14064 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14065 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14066 "Timers" below for more details.
14067
14068 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014069 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014070 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14071 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14072 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14073 details.
14074
14075 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14076 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14077 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14078 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14079 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14080
14081 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14082 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14083 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14084 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14085 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14086 for more details.
14087
14088 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014089 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014090 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14091 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14092 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014093 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014094
14095 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14096 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14097 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14098 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14099 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14100 caused by a denial of service attack.
14101
14102 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14103 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14104 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14105 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14106 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14107 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14108 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14109 denial of service attack.
14110
14111 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14112 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14113 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14114 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14115 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14116 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14117 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14118 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14119 be processed than on other servers.
14120
14121 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14122 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14123 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14124 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14125 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14126 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14127 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14128 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14129 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14130 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14131 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14132 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14133 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14134
14135 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14136 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14137 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14138 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14139 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14140 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14141 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14142 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14143
14144 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14145 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14146 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14147 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14148 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14149 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14150 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14151 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14152 occurs.
14153
14154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141558.2.3. HTTP log format
14156----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014157
14158The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14159is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14160the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14161are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14162emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14163generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14164"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14165which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014166frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14167is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014168
14169Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14170slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14171with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14172
14173 Example :
14174 frontend http-in
14175 mode http
14176 option httplog
14177 log global
14178 default_backend bck
14179
14180 backend static
14181 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14182
14183 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14184 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14185 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014186 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014187
14188 Field Format Extract from the example above
14189 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14190 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
14191 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
14192 4 frontend_name http-in
14193 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
14194 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
14195 7 status_code 200
14196 8 bytes_read* 2750
14197 9 captured_request_cookie -
14198 10 captured_response_cookie -
14199 11 termination_state ----
14200 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14201 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14202 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14203 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14204 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014205
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014206
14207Detailed fields description :
14208 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014209 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14210 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14211 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
14212 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
14213 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014214
14215 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014216 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14217 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14218 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014219
14220 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
14221 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
14222 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
14223 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
14224 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
14225
14226 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14227 and processed the connection.
14228
14229 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14230 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14231 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14232
14233 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14234 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14235 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14236 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14237 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14238 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14239
14240 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
14241 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
14242 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
14243 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
14244 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
14245 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
14246
14247 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14248 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14249 See "Timers" below for more details.
14250
14251 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14252 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14253 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14254 below for more details.
14255
14256 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14257 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14258 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14259 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14260 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14261 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14262 for more details.
14263
14264 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014265 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014266 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14267 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14268 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14269 details.
14270
14271 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14272 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14273 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14274
14275 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14276 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14277 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14278 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14279 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14280 overflowing.
14281
14282 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14283 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14284 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14285 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14286 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14287 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14288 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14289 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14290
14291 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14292 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14293 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14294 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14295 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14296 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14297 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14298 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14299
14300 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14301 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14302 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14303 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14304 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14305 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14306 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14307
14308 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014309 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014310 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
14311 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
14312 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014313 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014314 system.
14315
14316 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14317 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14318 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14319 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14320 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14321 caused by a denial of service attack.
14322
14323 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14324 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14325 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14326 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14327 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14328 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14329 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14330 denial of service attack.
14331
14332 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14333 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14334 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14335 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14336 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14337 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14338 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14339 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
14340 processed than on other servers.
14341
14342 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14343 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14344 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14345 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14346 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14347 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14348 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14349 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14350 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14351 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14352 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14353 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14354 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14355
14356 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14357 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14358 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14359 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14360 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14361 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14362 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14363 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14364
14365 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14366 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14367 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14368 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14369 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14370 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14371 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14372 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14373 occurs.
14374
14375 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
14376 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
14377 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
14378 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
14379 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
14380 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
14381 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
14382 cookies" below for more details.
14383
14384 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
14385 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
14386 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
14387 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
14388 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
14389 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14390 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14391 and cookies" below for more details.
14392
14393 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14394 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14395 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14396 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14397 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14398 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14399 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14400 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14401
14402
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200144038.2.4. Custom log format
14404------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014405
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014406The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014407mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014408
14409HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14410Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
14411separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
14412prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
14413
14414Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
14415variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
14416string formats ("Q").
14417
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014418If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020014419as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014420less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
14421the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
14422
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014423Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014424In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010014425in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014426
14427Flags are :
14428 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014429 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014430
14431 Example:
14432
14433 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
14434 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
14435
14436At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
14437
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014438 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
14439 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014440
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014441the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014442
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014443 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014444 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014445 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014446
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014447and the default TCP format is defined this way :
14448
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014449 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014450 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
14451
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014452Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
14453
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014454 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014455 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014456 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
14457 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
14458 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014459 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
14460 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
14461 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014462 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014463 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
14464 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000014465 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014466 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
14467 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014468 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020014469 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014470 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014471 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080014472 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014473 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
14474 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014475 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014476 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
14477 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014478 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014479 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
14480 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014481 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14482 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
14483 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014484 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014485 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
14486 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014487 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014488 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14489 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
14490 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014491 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020014492 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014493 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
14494 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
14495 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
14496 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020014497 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014498 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014499 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014500 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010014501 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014502 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014503 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
14504 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
14505 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014506 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014507 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
14508 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014509 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014510 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014511 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014512 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014513
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014514 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014515
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010014516
145178.2.5. Error log format
14518-----------------------
14519
14520When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
14521protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
14522By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
14523"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
14524will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
14525logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
14526
14527The format looks like this :
14528
14529 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
14530 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
14531 Connection error during SSL handshake
14532
14533 Field Format Extract from the example above
14534 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
14535 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
14536 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
14537 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
14538 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
14539
14540These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
14541failures.
14542
14543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145448.3. Advanced logging options
14545-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014546
14547Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
14548just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
14549options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
14550for more information about their usage.
14551
14552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145538.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
14554------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014555
14556It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
14557haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
14558commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
14559monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
14560ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
14561
14562 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
14563 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
14564 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
14565 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
14566
14567 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
14568 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
14569 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014570 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014571 such as other load-balancers.
14572
14573 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
14574 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
14575 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
14576
14577
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145788.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
14579----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014580
14581The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
14582what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
14583or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
14584"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
14585just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
14586log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
14587after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
14588is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
14589with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
14590with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
14591
14592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145938.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
14594------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014595
14596Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
14597for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
14598"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
14599retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
14600raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
14601a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
14602file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
14603you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
14604"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
14605
14606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
14608--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014609
14610Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
14611multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
14612them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
14613"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
14614logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
14615error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
14616and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
14617too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
14618useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
14619alternative.
14620
14621
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146228.4. Timing events
14623------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014624
14625Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
14626reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
14627the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
14628frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
14629mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
14630
14631 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
14632 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
14633 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
14634 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
14635 the client closes prematurely or times out.
14636
14637 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
14638 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
14639 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
14640 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
14641 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
14642
14643 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
14644 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
14645 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
14646 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
14647 connection never established.
14648
14649 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
14650 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
14651 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
14652 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
14653 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
14654 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
14655 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
14656 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
14657 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
14658 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
14659 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
14660
14661 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
14662 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
14663 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
14664 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014665 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014666
14667 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
14668
14669 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
14670 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
14671 negative.
14672
14673These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
14674protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
14675that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014676due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014677close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
14678session has been aborted on timeout.
14679
14680Most common cases :
14681
14682 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14683 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
14684 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
14685 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
14686 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
14687 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
14688 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
14689 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
14690 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020014691 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
14692 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
14693 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014694
14695 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14696 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
14697 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
14698 of ms on remote networks.
14699
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014700 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
14701 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
14702 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014703
14704 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
14705 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
14706 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
14707 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
14708 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
14709 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
14710 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
14711 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
14712 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
14713 to the server until another one is released.
14714
14715Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
14716
14717 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
14718 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
14719 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
14720
14721 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
14722 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
14723 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
14724
14725 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
14726 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
14727 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
14728 flags.
14729
14730 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
14731 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
14732 Check the session termination flags, then check the
14733 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
14734 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
14735 the client connection was maintained open.
14736
14737 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014738 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014739 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
14740 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
14741
14742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147438.5. Session state at disconnection
14744-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014745
14746TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
14747"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
147482-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
14749each of which has a special meaning :
14750
14751 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
14752 session to terminate :
14753
14754 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
14755
14756 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
14757 server explicitly refused it.
14758
14759 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
14760 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
14761 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
14762 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014763 (eg: cacheable cookie).
14764
14765 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
14766 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014767
14768 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
14769 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
14770 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
14771 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
14772 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
14773
14774 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
14775 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
14776 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
14777 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
14778 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
14779
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090014780 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
14781 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
14782
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014783 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
14784 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
14785 backup connections when going up.
14786
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020014787 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
14788
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014789 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
14790 send or receive data.
14791
14792 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
14793 send or receive data.
14794
14795 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
14796 with nothing left in the buffers.
14797
14798 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
14799
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010014800 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014801 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
14802
14803 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
14804 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
14805 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
14806 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
14807 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
14808
14809 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
14810 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
14811
14812 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
14813 server (HTTP only).
14814
14815 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
14816
14817 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
14818 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
14819 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
14820
14821 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
14822 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
14823 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
14824
14825 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
14826
14827 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
14828 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
14829
14830 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
14831 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
14832 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
14833
14834 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
14835 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020014836 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
14837 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014838
14839 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
14840 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
14841 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
14842 another server.
14843
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014844 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014845 server.
14846
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014847 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
14848 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
14849 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
14850 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14851
14852 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
14853 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
14854 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
14855 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14856
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020014857 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
14858 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
14859 "use-server" rule).
14860
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014861 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14862
14863 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
14864 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
14865
14866 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
14867
14868 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
14869 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
14870 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
14871
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014872 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
14873 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014874 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014875 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
14876 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
14877
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014878 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
14879
14880 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
14881 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
14882
14883 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
14884
14885 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14886
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014887The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
14888was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014889helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
14890starvation, attacks, etc...
14891
14892The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
14893alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
14894easier finding and understanding.
14895
14896 Flags Reason
14897
14898 -- Normal termination.
14899
14900 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
14901 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
14902 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
14903 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
14904
14905 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
14906 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
14907 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
14908 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
14909 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
14910 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014911
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014912 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14913 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014914 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014915
14916 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
14917 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
14918 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
14919
14920 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
14921 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
14922 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
14923 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
14924 the server takes too long to respond.
14925
14926 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
14927 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
14928 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
14929 long a time to respond.
14930
14931 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
14932 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
14933 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
14934 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014935 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
14936 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014937
14938 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
14939 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
14940 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
14941 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
14942 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014943 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014944 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
14945 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
14946 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
14947 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
14948 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
14949 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
14950 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
14951 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
14952 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
14953 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
14954 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
14955 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014956
14957 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
14958 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014959 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
14960 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
14961 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
14962 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014963
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014964 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
14965 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
14966
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014967 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014968 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
14969 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
14970 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
14971 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
14972 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
14973
14974 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
14975 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
14976 503 or 504 here.
14977
14978 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
14979 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
14980 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
14981 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
14982 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
14983
14984 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14985 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014986 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014987 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
14988 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
14989
14990 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
14991 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
14992 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
14993 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
14994 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
14995 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
14996 between haproxy and the server.
14997
14998 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
14999 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15000 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15001 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15002 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15003 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15004 solution is to fix the application.
15005
15006 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15007 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15008 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15009 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15010 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15011 external attacks.
15012
15013 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15014 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015015 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015016 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15017 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15018
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015019 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15020 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15021 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015022 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15023 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015024
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015025 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15026 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15027 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15028 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015029 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15030 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15031 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15032 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15033 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015034
15035 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15036 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15037 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15038 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15039
15040 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15041 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15042 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15043 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15044
15045 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15046 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15047 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15048 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15049
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015050The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15051persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15052important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15053re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15054
15055 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15056
15057 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15058 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15059 set on a GET request.
15060
15061 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15062 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015063 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015064 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15065
15066 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15067 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15068 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15069
15070 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15071 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15072 already got a cookie.
15073
15074 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15075 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15076 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15077 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15078 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15079
15080 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15081 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15082 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15083
15084 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15085 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15086 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15087
15088 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15089 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15090
15091 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15092 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15093 then advertised in the response.
15094
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150968.6. Non-printable characters
15097-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015098
15099In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15100consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15101converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15102prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15103being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15104escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15105is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15106'}' when logging headers.
15107
15108Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15109issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15110containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15111
15112Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15113the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15114performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15115
15116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151178.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15118---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015119
15120Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15121achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015122section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015123cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15124the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15125the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015126locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015127not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15128user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15129a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15130wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15131
15132 Examples :
15133 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15134 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15135
15136 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15137 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15138
15139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151408.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15141---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015142
15143Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15144proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15145the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15146server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15147
15148Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15149response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015150section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015151
15152It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015153time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15154appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015155are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15156and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15157follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15158request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15159in the logs.
15160
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015161As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15162frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15163an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15164
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015165 Example :
15166 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15167 listen proxy-out
15168 mode http
15169 option httplog
15170 option logasap
15171 log global
15172 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15173
15174 # log the name of the virtual server
15175 capture request header Host len 20
15176
15177 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15178 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15179
15180 # log the beginning of the referrer
15181 capture request header Referer len 20
15182
15183 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15184 capture response header Server len 20
15185
15186 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15187 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15188
15189 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15190 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15191
15192 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15193 capture response header Via len 20
15194
15195 # log the URL location during a redirection
15196 capture response header Location len 20
15197
15198 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15199 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15200 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15201 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15202 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15203
15204 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15205 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15206 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15207 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015208 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015209
15210 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15211 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15212 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15213 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15214 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015215 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015216
15217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152188.9. Examples of logs
15219---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015220
15221These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15222them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15223reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15224
15225 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15226 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15227 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15228
15229 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15230 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15231
15232 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15233 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15234 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15235
15236 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15237 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15238
15239 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15240 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15241 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15242
15243 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015244 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015245 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15246 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15247
15248 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15249 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15250 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15251
15252 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
15253 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020015254 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015255 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
15256 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
15257 to return the 502 and not the server.
15258
15259 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015260 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015261
15262 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
15263 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
15264 Nothing was sent to any server.
15265
15266 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
15267 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
15268
15269 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
15270 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
15271 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
15272 send a 408 return code to the client.
15273
15274 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
15275 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
15276
15277 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
15278 5 seconds ("c----").
15279
15280 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
15281 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015282 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015283
15284 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015285 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015286 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
15287 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
15288 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
15289 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
15290 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015291
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015292
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015293/*
15294 * Local variables:
15295 * fill-column: 79
15296 * End:
15297 */